]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
opts-common.c (decode_cmdline_option): Initialize separate_args.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050
JR
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
94@node Driver
95@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
96@cindex driver
97@cindex controlling the compilation driver
98
99@c prevent bad page break with this line
100You can control the compilation driver.
101
38f8b050
JR
102@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
103A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
104initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
105
106The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
107default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
108choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
109applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
110options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
111using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
112
113This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
114options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
115that the other specs are easier to write.
116
117Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
118@end defmac
119
120@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
121A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
122@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
123for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
124outermost pair of surrounding braces.
125
126The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
127the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
128to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
129@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
130everywhere it occurs.
131
132The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
133default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
134the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
135
136Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
137@end defmac
138
139@defmac CPP_SPEC
140A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
141pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
142give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
143
144Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
145@end defmac
146
147@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
148This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
149than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
150@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
151@end defmac
152
153@defmac CC1_SPEC
154A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
155pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
156front ends.
157It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
158for GCC to pass to front ends.
159
160Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
161@end defmac
162
163@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
164A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
165pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
166give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
167
168Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
169Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
170@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
171CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
172@end defmac
173
174@defmac ASM_SPEC
175A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
176pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
177you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
178See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
179
180Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
181@end defmac
182
183@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
184A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
185run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
186Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
187an example of this.
188
189Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
190@end defmac
191
192@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
193Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
194an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
195read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
196output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
197@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
198
199If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
200standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
201cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
202see @file{mips.h} for instance.
203@end defmac
204
205@defmac LINK_SPEC
206A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
207pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
208give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
209
210Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
211@end defmac
212
213@defmac LIB_SPEC
214Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
215between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
216command given to the linker.
217
218If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
219loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
220@end defmac
221
222@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
223Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
224how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
225linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
226the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
227
228If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
229passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
230@end defmac
231
232@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
233By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
234@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
235instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
236depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
237@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
238targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
239@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
240driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
241line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
242@end defmac
243
244@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
245A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
246mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
247generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
248static exception handler library, when linking without any of
249@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
250@end defmac
251
252@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
253If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
254When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
255the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
256@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
257@end defmac
258
259@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
260Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
261difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
262the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
263
264If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
265standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
266@end defmac
267
268@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
269Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
270difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
271the very end of the command given to the linker.
272
273Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
274@end defmac
275
276@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
277GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
278However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
279models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
280@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
281blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
282default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
283@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
284@end defmac
285
286@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
287Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
288configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
289et al, within sysroot+suffix.
290@end defmac
291
292@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
293Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
294GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
295updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
296usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
297@end defmac
298
299@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
300Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
301@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
302@code{CC1_SPEC}.
303
304The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
305containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
306string constant that provides the specification.
307
308Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
309
310@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
311related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
312to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
313these definitions.
314
315For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
316define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
317used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
318used.
319
320The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
321
322@smallexample
323#define EXTRA_SPECS \
324 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
325
326#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
327@end smallexample
328
329The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
330@smallexample
331#undef CPP_SPEC
332#define CPP_SPEC \
333"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
334%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
335%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
336%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
337
338#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
339#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
340@end smallexample
341
342while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
343@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
344
345@smallexample
346#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
347#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
348@end smallexample
349@end defmac
350
351@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
352Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
353@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
354the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
355@end defmac
356
357@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
358The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
359By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
360@end defmac
361
362@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
363A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
364linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
365change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
366define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
367line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
368the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
369@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
370@end defmac
371
372@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
373A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
374directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
375removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
376@end defmac
377
378@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
379Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
380string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
381target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
382@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
383
384Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
385the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
386@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
387@xref{Target Fragment}.
388@end defmac
389
390@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
391Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
392a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
393indicates an absolute file name.
394@end defmac
395
396@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
397If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
398@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
399when the compiler is built as a cross
400compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
401to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
402@end defmac
403
404@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
405Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
406standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
407try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
408@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
409is built as a cross compiler.
410@end defmac
411
412@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
413Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
414standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
415when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
416@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
417is built as a cross compiler.
418@end defmac
419
420@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
421Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
422standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
423default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
424@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
425is built as a cross compiler.
426@end defmac
427
428@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
429If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
430standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
431compiler is built as a cross compiler.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
435If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
436standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
437cross compiler.
438@end defmac
439
440@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
441Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
442variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
443loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
444initialize the necessary environment variables.
445@end defmac
446
447@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
448Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
449standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
450try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
451comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
452
453Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
454replacement.
455@end defmac
456
457@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
458Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
459system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
460directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
461@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
462
463Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
464specified.
465@end defmac
466
467@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
468Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
470try when searching for header files.
471
472Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
473@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
474@end defmac
475
476@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
477The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
478See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
479If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
480@end defmac
481
482@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
483Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
484for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
485usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
486@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
487@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
488and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
489and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
490@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
491
492The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
493Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
494string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
495for C++-only directories,
496and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
497wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
498the array with a null element.
499
500The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
501if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
502or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
503operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
504
505For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
506
507@smallexample
508#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
509@{ \
510 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
511 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
512 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
515@}
516@end smallexample
517@end defmac
518
519Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
520
521@enumerate
522@item
523Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
524
525@item
526The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
527is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
528@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
529
530@item
531The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
532
533@item
534The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
535in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
536
537@item
538The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
539
540@item
541The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
542
543@item
544The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
545compiler.
546@end enumerate
547
548Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
549
550@enumerate
551@item
552Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
553
554@item
555The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
556value based on the installed toolchain location.
557
558@item
559The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
560(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
561
562@item
563The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
564in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
565
566@item
567The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
568
569@item
570The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
571compiler.
572
573@item
574The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
575native compiler, or we have a target system root.
576
577@item
578The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
579native compiler, or we have a target system root.
580
581@item
582The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
583If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
584the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
585
586@item
587The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
588compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
589@file{/lib/}.
590
591@item
592The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
593compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
594@file{/usr/lib/}.
595@end enumerate
596
597@node Run-time Target
598@section Run-time Target Specification
599@cindex run-time target specification
600@cindex predefined macros
601@cindex target specifications
602
603@c prevent bad page break with this line
604Here are run-time target specifications.
605
606@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
607This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
608built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
609the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
610@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
611calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
612finished command line option processing your code can use those
613results freely.
614
615@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
616command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
617the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
618accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
619
620@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
621object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
622@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
623defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
624with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
625only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
626example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
627and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
628@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
629defines only @code{_ABI64}.
630
631You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
632@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
633or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
634assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
635macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
636to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
637variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
638@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
639preprocessing.
640@end defmac
641
642@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
643Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
644and is used for the target operating system instead.
645@end defmac
646
647@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
648Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
649and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
650macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
651it yourself.
652@end defmac
653
654@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
655This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
656any target-specific headers.
657@end deftypevar
658
659@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
660This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
661Its default setting is 0.
662@end deftypevr
663
664@cindex optional hardware or system features
665@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
666
667@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
668This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
669target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
670(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
671processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
672definition does nothing but return true.
673
674@var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
675associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
676the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
677underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
678no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
679(@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
680argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
681option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
682@end deftypefn
683
684@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
685This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
686target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
687definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
688option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
689valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
690default definition does nothing but return false.
691
692In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
693options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
694only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
695should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
696@end deftypefn
697
91ebb981
IS
698@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
699
700@hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
701
702@hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
26705988 703
38f8b050
JR
704@defmac TARGET_VERSION
705This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
706describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
707description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
708
709@smallexample
710#ifdef MOTOROLA
711#define TARGET_VERSION \
712 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
713#else
714#define TARGET_VERSION \
715 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
716#endif
717@end smallexample
718@end defmac
719
38f8b050
JR
720@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
721This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
722but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
723pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
724attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
725when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
726actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
727@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
728@end deftypefn
729
730@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
731This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
732but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
733language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
734used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
735frontends.
736@end defmac
737
3020190e 738@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
38f8b050 739Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
740various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
741options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
742options are processed once
38f8b050 743just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e
JM
744of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
745options passed explicily.
38f8b050 746
3020190e 747This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
38f8b050
JR
748options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
749@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 750@end deftypevr
38f8b050 751
7e4aae92
JM
752@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
753
128dc8e2
JM
754@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
755
38f8b050
JR
756@hook TARGET_HELP
757This hook is called in response to the user invoking
758@option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
759chance to display extra information on the target specific command
760line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
761@end deftypefn
762
3bd36029
RS
763@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
764Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
765during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
766the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
767can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
768and @code{nomips16} attributes.
769
770Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
771registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
772operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
773in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
774significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
775for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
776switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
777
778Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
779is 0.
780@end defmac
781
38f8b050
JR
782@node Per-Function Data
783@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
784@cindex per-function data
785@cindex data structures
786
787If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
788provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
789using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
790nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
791when another one comes along.
792
793GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
794contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
795structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
796@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
797to their own specific data.
798
799If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
800@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
801This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
802@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
803
804One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
805RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
806RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
807function, for level 0.
808
809Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
810all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
811function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
812stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
813stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
814@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
815the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
816single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
817longer supported.
818
819@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
820Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
821is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
822The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
823function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
824@end defmac
825
826@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
827If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
828function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
829target to perform any target specific initialization of the
830@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
831used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
832
833@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
834Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
835GC allocation, including the structure itself.
836@end deftypevar
837
838@node Storage Layout
839@section Storage Layout
840@cindex storage layout
841
842Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
843alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
844expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
845@xref{Run-time Target}.
846
847@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
848Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
849byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
850This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
851bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
852be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
853macro need not be a constant.
854
855This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
856bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
857@end defmac
858
859@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
860Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
861word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
862@end defmac
863
864@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
865Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
866most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
867memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
868order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
869macro need not be a constant.
870@end defmac
871
38f8b050
JR
872@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
873Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
874@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
875containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
876have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
877
878You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
879multi-word integers.
880@end defmac
881
882@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
883Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
884unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
885@end defmac
886
887@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
888Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
889is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
890@end defmac
891
892@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
893Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
894@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
895largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
896@end defmac
897
898@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
899Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
900register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
901@end defmac
902
903@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
904Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
905@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
906smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
907@end defmac
908
38f8b050
JR
909@defmac POINTER_SIZE
910Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
911width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
912you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
913a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
914@end defmac
915
916@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
917A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
918@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
919greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
920should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
921is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
922@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
923
924You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
925and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
926@end defmac
927
928@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
929A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
930is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
931stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
932scalar type.
933
934On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
935register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
936@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
937cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
938floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
939counterparts.
940
941For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
942However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
943either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
944the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
945sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
946@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
947
948Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
949@end defmac
950
951@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
952Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
953function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
954and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
955change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
956pointer} types.
957
958@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
959return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
960@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
961If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
962which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
963then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
964the signedness may be different.
965
966The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
967also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
968if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
969@end deftypefn
970
971@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
972Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
973bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
974regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
975size of an integer.
976@end defmac
977
978@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
979Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
980stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
981desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
982if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
983this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
984@end defmac
985
986@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
987Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
988stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
989is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
990macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
991@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
992@end defmac
993
994@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
995Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
996from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
997to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
998@end defmac
999
1000@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1001Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1002@end defmac
1003
1004@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1005Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1006bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1007just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1008@end defmac
1009
1010@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1011Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1012provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1013@end defmac
1014
1015@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1016Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1017not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1018@end defmac
1019
1020@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1021If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1022object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1023nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1024on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1025@end defmac
1026
1027@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1028Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1029machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1030structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1031by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1032@end defmac
1033
1034@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1035An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1036alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1037@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1038alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1039field alignment has not been set by the
1040@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1041@end defmac
1042
1043@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1044Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1045to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1046
1047If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1048
1049@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1050@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1051@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1052@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1053@end defmac
1054
1055@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1056Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1057Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1058@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1059the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1060
1061On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1062the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1063a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1064On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1065@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1066@end defmac
1067
1068@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1069If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1070the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1071the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1072macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1073
1074If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1075
1076@findex strcpy
1077One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1078make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1079arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1080constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1081@end defmac
1082
1083@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1084If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1085that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1086@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1087have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1088align the object.
1089
1090If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1091
1092The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1093constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1094constants can be done inline.
1095@end defmac
1096
1097@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1098If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1099the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1100the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1101macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1102
1103If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1104
1105One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1106make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1107@end defmac
1108
1109@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1110If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1111@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1112and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1113have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1114align the slot.
1115
1116If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1117@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1118be used.
1119
1120This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1121of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1122@end defmac
1123
1124@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1125If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1126variable @var{decl}.
1127
1128If this macro is not defined, then
1129@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1130is used.
1131
1132One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1133make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1134@end defmac
1135
1136@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1137If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1138for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1139@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1140
1141If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1142@end defmac
1143
1144@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1145Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1146empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1147
1148If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1149@end defmac
1150
1151@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1152Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1153Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1154
1155If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1156@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1157@end defmac
1158
1159@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1160Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1161if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1162go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1163@end defmac
1164
1165@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1166Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1167alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1168
1169The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1170@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1171structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1172that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1173that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1174
1175Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1176@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1177four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1178not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1179
1180An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1181structure.
1182
1183If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1184a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1185
1186Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1187bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1188support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1189@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1190
1191The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1192@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1193Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1194
1195Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1196@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1197@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1198
1199If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1200bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1201what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1202
1203@smallexample
1204struct foo1
1205@{
1206 char x;
1207 char :0;
1208 char y;
1209@};
1210
1211struct foo2
1212@{
1213 char x;
1214 int :0;
1215 char y;
1216@};
1217
1218main ()
1219@{
1220 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1221 sizeof (struct foo1));
1222 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1223 sizeof (struct foo2));
1224 exit (0);
1225@}
1226@end smallexample
1227
1228If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1229get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1230@end defmac
1231
1232@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1233Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1234to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1235@end defmac
1236
1237@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1238When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1239whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1240structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1241the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1242@end deftypefn
1243
1244@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1245This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1246should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1247these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1248
1249The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1250@end deftypefn
1251
1252@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1253Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1254@code{BLKMODE}.
1255
1256If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1257mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1258case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1259retain the field's mode.
1260
1261Normally, this is not needed.
1262@end defmac
1263
1264@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1265Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1266by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1267way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1268@var{specified}.
1269
1270The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1271the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1272@end defmac
1273
1274@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1275An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1276machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1277this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1278appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1279(DImode)} is assumed.
1280@end defmac
1281
1282@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1283If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1284specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1285@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1286@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1287@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1288having its mode specified.
1289
1290You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1291would most commonly define this macro if the
1292@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
129364-bit mode.
1294@end defmac
1295
1296@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1297If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1298specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1299@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1300
1301You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1302You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1303pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1304@end defmac
1305
1306@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1307This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1308of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1309@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1310targets.
1311@end deftypefn
1312
1313@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1314This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1315of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1316@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1317targets.
1318@end deftypefn
1319
1320@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1321Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1322The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1323@end deftypefn
1324
1325@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1326If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1327mode is towards zero.
1328
1329Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1330floating-point arithmetic.
1331
1332Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1333@end defmac
1334
1335@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1336This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1337bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1338exponent for normal numbers instead.
1339
1340Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1341floating-point arithmetic.
1342
1343The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1344@end defmac
1345
1346@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1347This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1348@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1349Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1350unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1351different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1352alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1353bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1354the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1355(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1356another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1357other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1358
1359When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1360of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1361bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1362and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1363chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1364size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1365alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1366
1367If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1368the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1369used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1370precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1371may affect its placement.
1372@end deftypefn
1373
1374@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1375Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1376@end deftypefn
1377
1378@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1379Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1380@end deftypefn
1381
1382@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1383This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1384to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1385For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1386for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1387registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1388usage.
1389@end deftypefn
1390
1391@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1392This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1393that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1394@end deftypefn
1395
1396@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1397If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1398uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1399to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1400mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1401the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1402not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1403for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1404return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1405string constant.
1406
1407Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1408qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1409fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1410is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1411length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1412ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1413@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1414@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1415code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1416@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1417codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1418spaces in your string.
1419
1420This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1421name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1422can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1423before mangling.
1424
1425The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1426appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1427types.
1428@end deftypefn
1429
1430@node Type Layout
1431@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1432
1433These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1434basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1435the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1436languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1437
1438@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1439A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1440target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1441@end defmac
1442
1443@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1444A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1445target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1446(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1447unit.)
1448@end defmac
1449
1450@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1451A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1452target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1453@end defmac
1454
1455@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1456On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1457@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1458that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1459the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1460value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1461@end defmac
1462
1463@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1464A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1465target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1466words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1467macro must be at least 64.
1468@end defmac
1469
1470@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1471A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1472target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1473@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1474@end defmac
1475
1476@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1477A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1478C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1479this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1480@end defmac
1481
1482@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1483A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1484target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1485@end defmac
1486
1487@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1488A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1489target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1490words.
1491@end defmac
1492
1493@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1494A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1495the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1496words.
1497@end defmac
1498
1499@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1500A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1501the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1502@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1503@end defmac
1504
1505@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1506A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1507the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1508@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1509@end defmac
1510
1511@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1512A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1513the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1514@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1515@end defmac
1516
1517@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1518A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1519the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1520@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1521@end defmac
1522
1523@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1524A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1525the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1526@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1527@end defmac
1528
1529@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1530A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1531the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1532@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1533@end defmac
1534
1535@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1536A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1537the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1538@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1539@end defmac
1540
1541@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1542A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1543the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1544@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1545@end defmac
1546
1547@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1548Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1549if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1550@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1551default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1552@end defmac
1553
1554@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1555Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1556@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1557@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1558anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1559or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1560otherwise it is 0.
1561@end defmac
1562
1563@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1564Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1565@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1566anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1567is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1568@end defmac
1569
1570@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1571Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1572@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1573anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1574is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1575@end defmac
1576
1577@defmac SF_SIZE
1578@defmacx DF_SIZE
1579@defmacx XF_SIZE
1580@defmacx TF_SIZE
1581Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1582@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1583if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1584@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1585for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1586@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1587@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1588@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1589@end defmac
1590
1591@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1592A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1593assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1594default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1595@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1596@end defmac
1597
1598@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1599A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1600supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1601value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1602If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1603is the default.
1604@end defmac
1605
1606@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1607An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1608@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1609always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1610and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1611@end defmac
1612
1613@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1614This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1615@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1616of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1617@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1618
1619The default is to return false.
1620@end deftypefn
1621
1622@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1623A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1624for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1625contents of the string.
1626
1627The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1628spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1629appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1630of the data type names defined in the function
1631@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1632omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1633crash on startup.
1634
1635If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1636int"}.
1637@end defmac
1638
1639@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1640A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1641for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1642@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1643@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1644
1645If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1646@end defmac
1647
1648@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1649A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1650for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1651the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1652information.
1653
1654If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1655@end defmac
1656
1657@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1658A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1659characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1660@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1661@end defmac
1662
1663@defmac WINT_TYPE
1664A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1665use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1666@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1667contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1668information.
1669
1670If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1671@end defmac
1672
1673@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1674A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1675can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1676The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1677string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1678
1679If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1680@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1681much precision as @code{long long int}.
1682@end defmac
1683
1684@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1685A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1686can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1687type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1688of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1689
1690If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1691@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1692unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1693int}.
1694@end defmac
1695
1696@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1697@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1698@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1699@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1700@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1701@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1702@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1703@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1704@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1705@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1706@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1707@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1708@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1709@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1710@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1711@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1712@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1713@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1714@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1715@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1716@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1717@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1718@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1719@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1720@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1721@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1722@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1723C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1724@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1725@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1726@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1727@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1728@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1729@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1730@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1731@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1732@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1733
1734If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1735type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1736@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1737to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1738these macros are null pointers.
1739@end defmac
1740
1741@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1742The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1743that looks like:
1744
1745@smallexample
1746 struct @{
1747 union @{
1748 void (*fn)();
1749 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1750 @};
1751 ptrdiff_t delta;
1752 @};
1753@end smallexample
1754
1755@noindent
1756The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1757will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1758Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1759always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1760distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1761platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1762that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1763the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1764
1765GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1766this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1767However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1768set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1769bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1770address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1771architecture, you should define this macro to
1772@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1773
1774In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1775in which function addresses are always even, according to
1776@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1777@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1778@end defmac
1779
1780@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1781Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1782macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1783instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1784function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1785data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1786pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1787
1788If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1789of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1790@end defmac
1791
1792@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1793By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1794is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1795the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1796when special alignment is necessary. */
1797@end defmac
1798
1799@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1800There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1801zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1802specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1803of words in each data entry.
1804@end defmac
1805
1806@node Registers
1807@section Register Usage
1808@cindex register usage
1809
1810This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1811has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1812
1813The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1814done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1815on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1816For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1817For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1818
1819@menu
1820* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1821* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1822* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1823* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1824* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1825@end menu
1826
1827@node Register Basics
1828@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1829
1830@c prevent bad page break with this line
1831Registers have various characteristics.
1832
1833@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1834Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1835numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1836pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1837@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1838@end defmac
1839
1840@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1841@cindex fixed register
1842An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1843all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1844general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1845pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1846register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1847machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1848and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1849
1850This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1851commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1852register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1853
1854The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1855the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1856by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1857the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1858@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1859@end defmac
1860
1861@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1862@cindex call-used register
1863@cindex call-clobbered register
1864@cindex call-saved register
1865Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1866clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1867registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1868available for general allocation of values that must live across
1869function calls.
1870
1871If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1872automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1873exit, if the register is used within the function.
1874@end defmac
1875
1876@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1877@cindex call-used register
1878@cindex call-clobbered register
1879@cindex call-saved register
1880Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1881that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1882(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1883This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1884of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1885@end defmac
1886
1887@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1888@cindex call-used register
1889@cindex call-clobbered register
1890@cindex call-saved register
1891A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1892value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1893call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1894macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1895preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1896@end defmac
1897
1898@findex fixed_regs
1899@findex call_used_regs
1900@findex global_regs
1901@findex reg_names
1902@findex reg_class_contents
1903@defmac CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1904Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1905@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1906@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1907any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1908of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1909@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1910@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1911called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1912@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1913from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1914@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1915@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1916@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1917command options have been applied.
1918
1919You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1920
1921@cindex disabling certain registers
1922@cindex controlling register usage
1923If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1924flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1925@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1926registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1927the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1928to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1929is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1930
1931(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1932of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1933controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1934these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1935@end defmac
1936
1937@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1938Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1939expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1940corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1941function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1942outbound register.
1943@end defmac
1944
1945@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1946Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1947expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1948corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1949function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1950register.
1951@end defmac
1952
1953@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1954Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1955expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1956register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1957need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1958gotos.
1959@end defmac
1960
1961@defmac PC_REGNUM
1962If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1963register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1964@end defmac
1965
1966@node Allocation Order
1967@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1968@cindex order of register allocation
1969@cindex register allocation order
1970
1971@c prevent bad page break with this line
1972Registers are allocated in order.
1973
1974@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1975If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1976numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1977to use them (from most preferred to least).
1978
1979If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1980(all else being equal).
1981
1982One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1983registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1984instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1985machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1986the highest numbered allocable register first.
1987@end defmac
1988
1989@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1990A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1991hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1992
1993Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1994Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1995register; and so on.
1996
1997The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1998@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1999
2000On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2001@end defmac
2002
2003@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2004Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2005prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2006using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2007allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2008call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2009should be defined.
2010@end defmac
2011
2012@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2013In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2014Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2015If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2016based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2017be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2018value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2019to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2020
2021On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2022@end defmac
2023
2024@node Values in Registers
2025@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2026
2027This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2028(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2029consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2030
2031@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2032A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2033at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2034@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2035cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2036and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2037
2038On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2039definition of this macro is
2040
2041@smallexample
2042#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2043 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2044 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2045@end smallexample
2046@end defmac
2047
2048@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2049A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2050in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2051in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2052multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2053this mode by the number of registers returned by
2054@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2055
2056For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2057registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2058nonzero.
2059
2060This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2061@code{subreg_get_info}
2062would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2063represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2064@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2065registers and so not be representable.
2066@end defmac
2067
2068@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2069For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2070@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2071returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2072including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2073@end defmac
2074
2075@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2076Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2077of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2078should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2079used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2080happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2081floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2082@end defmac
2083
2084@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2085A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2086of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2087registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2088are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2089
2090@smallexample
2091#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2092@end smallexample
2093
2094You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2095because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2096
2097@cindex register pairs
2098On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2099register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2100odd register numbers for such modes.
2101
2102The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2103@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2104register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2105value into the register and back out not alter it.
2106
2107Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2108all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2109@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2110you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2111is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2112and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2113to be tieable.
2114
2115Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2116Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2117in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2118can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2119mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2120registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2121
2122On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2123modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2124registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2125non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2126@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2127floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2128normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2129unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2130register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2131
2132The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2133they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2134instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2135@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2136constraints for those instructions.
2137
2138On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2139so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2140register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2141floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2142be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2143@end defmac
2144
2145@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2146A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2147@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2148
2149One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2150another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2151handler.
2152
2153The default is always nonzero.
2154@end defmac
2155
2156@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2157A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2158@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2159
2160If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2161@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2162any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2163should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2164this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2165accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2166
2167You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2168possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2169allocation.
2170@end defmac
2171
2172@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2173This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2174@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2175
2176One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2177is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2178
2179The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2180@end deftypefn
2181
2182@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2183Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2184registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2185@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2186@end defmac
2187
2188@node Leaf Functions
2189@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2190
2191@cindex leaf functions
2192@cindex functions, leaf
2193On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2194more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2195means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2196are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2197normally arrive.
2198
2199The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2200other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2201registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2202function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2203handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2204functions''.
2205
2206GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2207suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2208registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2209accomplish this.
2210
2211@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2212Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2213contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2214function treatment.
2215
2216If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2217registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2218GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2219used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2220in this vector.
2221
2222Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2223the treatment of leaf functions.
2224@end defmac
2225
2226@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2227A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2228should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2229
2230If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2231function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2232will cause the compiler to abort.
2233
2234Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2235treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2236this.
2237@end defmac
2238
2239@findex current_function_is_leaf
2240@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2241@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2242@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2243specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2244which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2245set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2246compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2247@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2248functions which only use leaf registers.
2249@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2250that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2251@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2252@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2253@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2254
2255@node Stack Registers
2256@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2257
2258There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2259``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2260pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2261stack.
2262
2263Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2264they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2265support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2266point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2267stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2268@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2269with it, as well as defining these macros.
2270
2271@defmac STACK_REGS
2272Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2273@end defmac
2274
2275@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2276This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2277the machine has any stack-like registers.
2278@end defmac
2279
2280@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2281The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2282of the stack.
2283@end defmac
2284
2285@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2286The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2287the stack.
2288@end defmac
2289
2290@node Register Classes
2291@section Register Classes
2292@cindex register class definitions
2293@cindex class definitions, register
2294
2295On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2296For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2297certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2298restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2299
2300You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2301which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2302that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2303
2304@findex ALL_REGS
2305@findex NO_REGS
2306In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2307class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2308class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2309union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2310
2311@findex GENERAL_REGS
2312One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2313terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2314@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2315the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2316to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2317
2318Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2319then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2320
2321The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2322constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2323You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2324them in operand constraints.
2325
2326You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2327instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2328either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2329certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2330which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2331
2332You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2333classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2334contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2335in their union.
2336
2337When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2338certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2339Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2340a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2341specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2342
2343Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2344instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2345each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2346mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2347single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2348this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2349instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2350single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2351@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2352
2353@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2354An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2355as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2356must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2357@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2358tells how many classes there are.
2359
2360Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2361the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2362in many of the tables described below.
2363@end deftp
2364
2365@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2366The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2367
2368@smallexample
2369#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2370@end smallexample
2371@end defmac
2372
2373@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2374An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2375constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2376@end defmac
2377
2378@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2379An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2380which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2381@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2382register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2383
2384When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2385Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2386several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2387for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2388In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2389registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2390so on.
2391@end defmac
2392
2393@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2394A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2395@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2396which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2397register.
2398@end defmac
2399
2400@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2401A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2402base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2403which is the register value plus a displacement.
2404@end defmac
2405
2406@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2407This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2408the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2409@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2410@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2411@end defmac
2412
2413@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2414A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2415base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2416register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2417addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2418@end defmac
2419
2420@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2421A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2422base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2423context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2424the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2425address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2426@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2427index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2428@end defmac
2429
2430@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2431A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2432index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2433address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2434added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2435@end defmac
2436
2437@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2438A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2439suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
38f8b050
JR
2440@end defmac
2441
2442@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2443A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2444that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2445@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2446reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2447you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2448@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2449addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2450@code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2451@end defmac
2452
2453@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2454A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2455use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2456memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2457pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2458define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2459than other base register uses.
2460
2461Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2462@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
38f8b050
JR
2463@end defmac
2464
2465@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2466A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2467that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2468appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2469immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2470address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2471@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2472corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2473@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2474that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2475@end defmac
2476
2477@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2478A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2479suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2480either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2481allocated such a hard register.
2482
2483The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2484the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2485two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2486labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2487labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2488may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2489looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2490only if neither labeling works.
38f8b050
JR
2491@end defmac
2492
fba42e24
AS
2493@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2494A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2495to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2496@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2497another, smaller class.
2498
2499The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2500
2501Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2502example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2503for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2504@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2505Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2506
2507One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2508@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2509loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2510force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2511immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2512instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2513register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2514@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2515into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2516@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2517of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2518
2519If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2520through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2521to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2522reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2523this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2524the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2525@end deftypefn
2526
38f8b050
JR
2527@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2528A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2529to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2530@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2531another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2532safe:
2533
2534@smallexample
2535#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2536@end smallexample
2537
2538Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2539example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2540for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2541@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2542Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2543
2544One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2545@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2546loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2547force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2548immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2549instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2550register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2551@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2552into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2553@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2554of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2555
2556If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2557through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2558to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2559reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2560this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2561the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2562@end defmac
2563
2564@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2565Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2566input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2567@var{class}, unchanged.
2568
2569You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2570reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2571@end defmac
2572
abd26bfb
AS
2573@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2574Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2575input reloads.
2576
2577The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2578argument.
2579
2580You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2581reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2582@end deftypefn
2583
38f8b050
JR
2584@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2585A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2586to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2587@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2588ordinarily be used.
2589
2590Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2591there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2592
2593The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2594smaller class.
2595
2596Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2597require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2598@end defmac
2599
2600@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2601Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2602from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2603@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2604from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2605term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2606directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2607register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2608destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2609source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2610reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2611and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2612intermediate register still holds the required value.
2613
2614Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2615allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2616register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2617address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2618when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2619as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2620that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2621describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2622these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2623of the scratch register(s).
2624
2625In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2626
2627For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2628and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2629@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2630hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2631needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2632
2633If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2634an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2635return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2636If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2637If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2638that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2639
2640If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2641perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2642closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2643required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2644copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2645
2646You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2647in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2648and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2649for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2650single-register-class
2651@c [later: or memory]
2652output constraint.
2653
2654When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2655hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2656register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2657have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2658
2659@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2660@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2661@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2662@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2663@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2664@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2665@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2666@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2667
2668
2669@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2670pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2671Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2672in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2673
2674Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2675currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2676to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2677
2678@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2679copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2680(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2681Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2682of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2683forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2684@end deftypefn
2685
2686@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2687@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2688@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2689These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2690@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2691
2692These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2693target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2694reload phase that it may
2695need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2696register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2697register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2698you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2699largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2700intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2701
2702If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2703intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2704was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2705class required. If the
2706requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2707@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2708macros identically.
2709
2710The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2711Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2712can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2713@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2714macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2715
2716If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2717intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2718@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2719(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2720implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2721@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2722register.
2723
2724These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2725register that
2726contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2727class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2728value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2729register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2730Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2731
2732@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2733pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2734Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2735in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2736
2737These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2738registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2739registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2740would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2741the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2742intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2743general registers.
2744@end defmac
2745
2746@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2747Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2748to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2749those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2750@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2751class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2752and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2753
2754Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2755@end defmac
2756
2757@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2758Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2759allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2760If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2761defined by this macro.
2762
2763Do not define this macro if you do not define
2764@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2765@end defmac
2766
2767@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2768When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2769registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2770hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2771load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2772same as that of @var{mode}.
2773
2774This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2775bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2776in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2777registers.
2778
2779However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2780the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2781differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2782widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2783suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2784details.
2785
2786Do not define this macro if you do not define
2787@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2788is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2789@end defmac
2790
07b8f0a8
AS
2791@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2792A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2793to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2794registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2795
2796The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2797has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2798default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2799if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2800hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2801@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2802@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2803register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2804you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2805the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2806allocation.
2807@end deftypefn
2808
38f8b050
JR
2809@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2810A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2811of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2812
2813This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2814the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2815should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2816@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2817
2818This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2819in the reload pass.
2820@end defmac
2821
2822@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2823If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2824a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2825
2826For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2827floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2828Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2829does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2830register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2831as below:
2832
2833@smallexample
2834#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2835 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2836 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2837@end smallexample
2838@end defmac
2839
2840@hook TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2841Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
2842(@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2843classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
2844purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
2845possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
2846The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2847
2848The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2849have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2850the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2851
2852This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2853options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2854@code{target_reinit}.
2855
2856The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2857otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2858macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
2859allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2860the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
2861@end deftypefn
2862
2863@defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2864See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
2865@end defmac
2866
2867@node Old Constraints
2868@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2869@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2870@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2871
2872Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2873of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2874Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2875it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2876
2877@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2878For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2879@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2880constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2881you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2882constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2883DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2884to handle specially.
2885There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2886for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2887transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2888return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2889will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2890@end defmac
2891
2892@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2893A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2894letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2895value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2896the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2897corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2898to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2899@end defmac
2900
2901@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2902Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2903passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2904different variants.
2905@end defmac
2906
2907@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2908A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2909letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2910particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2911letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2912the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2913not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2914@var{value}.
2915@end defmac
2916
2917@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2918Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2919string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2920between different variants.
2921@end defmac
2922
2923@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2924A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2925letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2926(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2927
2928If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2929@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2930range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2931letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2932
2933@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2934@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2935or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2936between these kinds.
2937@end defmac
2938
2939@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2940Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2941string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2942between different variants.
2943@end defmac
2944
2945@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2946A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2947letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2948memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2949elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2950@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2951may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2952
2953If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2954if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2955constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2956constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2957
2958For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2959in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2960letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2961@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2962a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2963alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2964does not include r0 on the output.
2965@end defmac
2966
2967@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2968Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2969in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2970variants.
2971@end defmac
2972
2973@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2974A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2975letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2976be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2977
2978It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2979at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2980comprises a subset of all memory references including
2981all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2982pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2983type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2984
2985For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2986memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2987register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2988@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2989If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2990a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2991reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2992into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2993an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2994@end defmac
2995
2996@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2997A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2998letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
2999@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3000be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3001
3002It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3003at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3004a subset of all memory addresses including
3005all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3006pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3007type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3008
3009Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3010be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3011analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3012@end defmac
3013
3014@node Stack and Calling
3015@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3016@cindex calling conventions
3017
3018@c prevent bad page break with this line
3019This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3020
3021@menu
3022* Frame Layout::
3023* Exception Handling::
3024* Stack Checking::
3025* Frame Registers::
3026* Elimination::
3027* Stack Arguments::
3028* Register Arguments::
3029* Scalar Return::
3030* Aggregate Return::
3031* Caller Saves::
3032* Function Entry::
3033* Profiling::
3034* Tail Calls::
3035* Stack Smashing Protection::
3036@end menu
3037
3038@node Frame Layout
3039@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3040@cindex stack frame layout
3041@cindex frame layout
3042
3043@c prevent bad page break with this line
3044Here is the basic stack layout.
3045
3046@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3047Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3048pointer to a smaller address.
3049
3050When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3051compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3052definition used does not matter.
3053@end defmac
3054
3055@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3056This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3057on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3058@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3059
3060The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3061and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3062the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3063to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3064space for the next item on the stack.
3065
3066The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3067defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3068which is often wrong.
3069@end defmac
3070
3071@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3072Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3073are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3074@end defmac
3075
3076@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3077Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3078addresses on the stack.
3079@end defmac
3080
3081@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3082Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3083
3084If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3085subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3086Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3087value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3088@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3089@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3090@end defmac
3091
3092@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3093Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3094The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3095
3096On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3097is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3098alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3099stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3100@end defmac
3101
3102@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3103Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3104outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3105zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3106
3107If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3108the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3109@end defmac
3110
3111@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3112Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3113address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3114function.
3115
3116If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3117the first argument's address.
3118@end defmac
3119
3120@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3121Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3122on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3123
3124The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3125length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3126machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3127@end defmac
3128
3129@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3130A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3131stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3132@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3133default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3134elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3135@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3136@end defmac
3137
3138@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3139A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3140frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3141@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3142itself.
3143
3144If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3145of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3146address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3147@end defmac
3148
3149@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3150If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3151setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3152on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3153before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3154define this macro.
3155@end defmac
3156
3157@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3158This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3159the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3160The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3161machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3162@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3163@end deftypefn
3164
3165@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3166A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3167address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3168of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3169You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3170as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3171@end defmac
3172
3173@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3174A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3175address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3176the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3177frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3178@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3179
3180The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3181@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3182determine the return address of other frames.
3183@end defmac
3184
3185@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3186Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3187from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3188@end defmac
3189
3190@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3191A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3192incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3193prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3194value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3195the stack.
3196
3197You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3198debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3199
3200If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3201@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3202@end defmac
3203
3204@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3205A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3206number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3207must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3208be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3209
3210This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3211general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3212frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3213over time.
3214@end defmac
3215
3216@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3217A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3218number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3219only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3220someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3221terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3222@end defmac
3223
3224@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3225This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3226contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3227info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3228@smallexample
3229(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3230@end smallexample
3231and
3232@smallexample
3233(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3234@end smallexample
3235to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3236the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3237the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3238@end deftypefn
3239
3240@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3241A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3242from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3243frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3244the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3245previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3246
3247You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3248debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3249@end defmac
3250
3251@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3252A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3253from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3254final value should coincide with that calculated by
3255@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3256during virtual register instantiation.
3257
3258The default value for this macro is
3259@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3260which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3261immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3262some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3263and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3264
3265You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3266want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3267DWARF 2.
3268@end defmac
3269
3270@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3271If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3272in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3273The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3274@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3275
3276Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3277via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3278variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3279defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3280based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3281of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3282should be defined.
3283@end defmac
3284
3285@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3286If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3287in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3288in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3289may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3290@end defmac
3291
3292@node Exception Handling
3293@subsection Exception Handling Support
3294@cindex exception handling
3295
3296@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3297A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3298data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3299@var{N} registers are usable.
3300
3301The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3302handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3303should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3304but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
33052 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3306
3307You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3308handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3309@end defmac
3310
3311@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3312A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3313to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3314This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3315It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3316
3317Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3318untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3319
3320Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3321by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3322this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3323stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3324this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3325that provided by DWARF 2.
3326@end defmac
3327
3328@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3329A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3330to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3331return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3332
3333Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3334return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3335address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3336the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3337frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3338been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3339target call frame.
3340
3341Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3342address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3343the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3344
3345If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3346define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3347@end defmac
3348
3349@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3350If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3351to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3352exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3353using it to return to the exception handler.
3354@end defmac
3355
3356@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3357This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3358handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3359that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3360and so may be read-only.
3361
3362@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3363@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3364The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3365as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3366
3367If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3368represented directly.
3369@end defmac
3370
3371@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3372This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3373to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3374Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3375be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3376
3377This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3378handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3379of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3380to be emitted.
3381@end defmac
3382
3383@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3384A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3385so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3386@end defmac
3387
3388@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3389This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3390code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3391available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3392through signal frames.
3393
3394This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3395@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3396@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3397@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3398for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3399the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3400save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3401evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3402the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3403
3404For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3405@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3406@end defmac
3407
3408@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3409This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3410call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3411usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3412
3413This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3414@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3415@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3416for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3417@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3418be updated in @var{fs}.
3419@end defmac
3420
3421@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3422A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3423info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3424linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3425@end defmac
3426
3427@node Stack Checking
3428@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3429
3430GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3431stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3432three ways:
3433
3434@enumerate
3435@item
3436If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3437will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3438at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3439other special processing.
3440
3441@item
3442If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3443@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3444that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3445static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3446in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3447stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3448approach below.
3449
3450@item
3451If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3452``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3453@end enumerate
3454
3455If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3456GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3457@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3458dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3459
3460@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3461A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3462machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3463is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3464checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3465value of this macro is zero.
3466@end defmac
3467
3468@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3469A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3470in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3471like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3472approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3473@end defmac
3474
3475@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3476An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3477instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3478define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3479the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3480of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3481@end defmac
3482
3483@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3484An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3485when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3486contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3487thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3488is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3489default value of this macro is zero.
3490@end defmac
3491
3492@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3493The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3494languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3495with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
34968192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3497most machines.
3498@end defmac
3499
3500The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3501nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3502in the opposite case.
3503
3504@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3505The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3506instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3507stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3508checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3509default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3510systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3511@end defmac
3512
3513@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3514GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3515represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3516space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3517You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3518use the default of four words.
3519@end defmac
3520
3521@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3522The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3523fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3524@option{-fstack-check}.
3525GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3526normally not need to override that default.
3527@end defmac
3528
3529@need 2000
3530@node Frame Registers
3531@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3532
3533@c prevent bad page break with this line
3534This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3535
3536@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3537The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3538fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3539the hardware determines which register this is.
3540@end defmac
3541
3542@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3543The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3544access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3545hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3546choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3547@end defmac
3548
3549@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3550On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3551offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3552allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3553between these two locations). On those machines, define
3554@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3555be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3556@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3557used for the frame pointer.
3558
3559You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3560is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3561the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3562completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3563definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3564@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3565or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3566
3567Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3568@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3569@end defmac
3570
3571@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3572The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3573the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3574frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3575register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3576wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3577pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3578@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3579(@pxref{Elimination}).
3580@end defmac
3581
e3339d0f
JM
3582@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3583Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3584@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3585the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3586== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3587definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3588@end defmac
3589
3590@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3591Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3592@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3593same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3594ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3595definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3596@end defmac
3597
38f8b050
JR
3598@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3599The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3600access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3601machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3602pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3603to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3604@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3605
3606Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3607address from the stack.
3608@end defmac
3609
3610@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3611@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3612Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3613register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3614function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3615number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3616these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3617not be defined.
3618
3619The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3620
3621If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3622defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3623@end defmac
3624
3625@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3626This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3627targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3628nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3629attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3630those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3631
3632The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3633
3634If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3635provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3636Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3637from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3638will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3639@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3640@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3641@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3642The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3643@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3644to refer to those items.
3645@end deftypefn
3646
3647@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3648This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3649saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3650DWARF2 exception handling.
3651
3652Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3653exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3654extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3655in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3656used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3657routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3658registers that are not call-saved.
3659
3660If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3661@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3662@end defmac
3663
3664@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3665
3666This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3667for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3668
3669If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3670@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3671@end defmac
3672
3673@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3674
3675Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3676is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3677Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3678column number to use instead.
3679
3680See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3681@end defmac
3682
3683@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3684
3685Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3686used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3687debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3688should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3689@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3690
3691@end defmac
3692
3693@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3694
3695Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3696that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3697should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3698.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3699return @code{@var{regno}}.
3700
3701@end defmac
3702
3703@node Elimination
3704@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3705
3706@c prevent bad page break with this line
3707This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3708
3709@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3710This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3711a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3712value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3713
3714This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3715according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3716constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3717to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3718Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3719pointer.
3720
3721In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3722without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3723automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3724@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3725them.
3726
3727In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3728register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3729fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3730
3731Default return value is @code{false}.
3732@end deftypefn
3733
3734@findex get_frame_size
3735@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3736A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3737between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3738the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3739such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3740registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3741
3742If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3743need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3744@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3745case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3746@end defmac
3747
3748@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3749If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3750eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3751defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3752references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3753
3754The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3755of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3756
3757On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3758the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3759must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3760replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3761depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3762
3763In this case, you might specify:
3764@smallexample
3765#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3766@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3767 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3768 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3769@end smallexample
3770
3771Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3772specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3773@end defmac
3774
3775@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3776This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3777try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3778@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3779is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3780preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3781knows about.
3782
3783Default return value is @code{true}.
3784@end deftypefn
3785
3786@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3787This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3788specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3789registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3790defined.
3791@end defmac
3792
3793@node Stack Arguments
3794@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3795@cindex arguments on stack
3796@cindex stack arguments
3797
3798The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3799on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3800control passing certain arguments in registers.
3801
3802@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3803This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3804prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3805passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3806cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3807The default is to not promote prototypes.
3808@end deftypefn
3809
3810@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3811A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3812outgoing arguments.
3813If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3814That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3815allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3816it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3817@end defmac
3818
3819@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3820A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3821last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3822defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3823and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3824@end defmac
3825
3826@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3827A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3828stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3829
3830On some machines, the definition
3831
3832@smallexample
3833#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3834@end smallexample
3835
3836@noindent
3837will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3838to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3839alignment. Then the definition should be
3840
3841@smallexample
3842#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3843@end smallexample
3844@end defmac
3845
3846@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3847@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3848A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3849will be computed and placed into the variable
3850@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3851onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3852increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3853
3854Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3855is not proper.
3856@end defmac
3857
3858@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3859Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3860allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3861registers.
3862
3863The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3864arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3865which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3866The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3867of the function.
3868
3869This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3870machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3871which.
3872@end defmac
3873@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3874@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3875
3876@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3877Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3878caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3879when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3880if the function called is a library function.
3881
3882If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3883whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3884@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3885@end defmac
3886
3887@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3888Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3889stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3890@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3891@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3892
3893Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3894stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3895suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3896stack in its natural location.
3897@end defmac
3898
893d13d5 3899@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3900This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3901a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3902and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3903
3904@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3905the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3906@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3907From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3908
3909@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3910describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3911@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3912From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3913arguments (if known).
3914
3915When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3916will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3917you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3918by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3919a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3920in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3921
893d13d5 3922@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
3923stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3924argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3925
3926On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3927of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
3928calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3929the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3930convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3931arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3932nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3933@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3934number of arguments.
3935@end deftypefn
3936
3937@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3938A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3939pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3940when compiling a function call.
3941
3942@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3943have been accumulated.
3944
3945On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3946that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3947that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3948call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3949appropriate.
3950@end defmac
3951
3952@node Register Arguments
3953@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3954@cindex arguments in registers
3955@cindex registers arguments
3956
3957This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3958types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3959the stack.
3960
3961@defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
3962A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
3963in a register, and which register.
3964
3965The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
3966arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3967the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3968(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3969which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
3970correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
3971@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
3972occurred.
3973
3974The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
3975hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
3976argument on the stack.
3977
3978For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
3979pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
3980
3981The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3982used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3983@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3984@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3985describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3986@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3987register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3988register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3989second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3990the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3991As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3992RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3993argument is also stored on the stack.
3994
3995The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3996VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3997pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3998
3999@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4000The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
4001where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4002nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4003by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4004
4005@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4006@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4007You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4008in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4009type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4010is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4011argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4012defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4013a register.
4014@end defmac
4015
4016@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4017This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4018solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4019definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4020documentation.
4021@end deftypefn
4022
4023@defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4024Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4025that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4026necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4027argument.
4028
4029For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4030the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4031be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4032where the arguments will arrive.
4033
4034If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4035serves both purposes.
4036@end defmac
4037
4038@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4039This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4040argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4041arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4042pushed on the stack.
4043
4044On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4045registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4046first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4047on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4048structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4049in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4050compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4051
4052@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4053register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4054@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4055@end deftypefn
4056
ec9f85e5 4057@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4058This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4059position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4060predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4061passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4062
4063If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4064pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4065The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4066to that type.
4067@end deftypefn
4068
4069@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4070The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4071known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4072function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4073by the caller.
4074
4075For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4076determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4077not be generated.
4078
4079The default version of this hook always returns false.
4080@end deftypefn
4081
4082@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4083A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4084@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4085the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4086argument so far.
4087
4088There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4089arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4090variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4091arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4092@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4093should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4094@end defmac
4095
4096@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4097If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4098function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4099created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4100reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4101If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4102@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4103@end defmac
4104
4105@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4106A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4107@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4108variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4109is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4110the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4111For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4112declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4113@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4114being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4115arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4116parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4117@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4118
4119When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4120@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4121contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4122an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4123macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4124never both of them at once.
4125@end defmac
4126
4127@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4128Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4129it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4130@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4131is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41320)} is used instead.
4133@end defmac
4134
4135@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4136Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4137finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4138undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4139
4140The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4141with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4142argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4143@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4144@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4145@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4146@end defmac
4147
4148@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4149A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4150@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4151values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4152Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
4153the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4154
4155This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4156on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4157used for arguments without any special help.
4158@end defmac
4159
4160@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4161If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4162offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4163which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4164slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4165top.
4166@end defmac
4167
4168@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4169If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4170to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4171@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4172@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4173
4174The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4175multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
4176it.
4177
4178This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4179For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4180big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4181constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4182@end defmac
4183
4184@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4185If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4186implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4187next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4188controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4189arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4190@end defmac
4191
4192@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4193Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4194memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4195macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4196machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4197@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4198registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4199a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4200required.
4201@end defmac
4202
4203@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4204If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
4205of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
4206@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
4207@end defmac
4208
4209@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4210A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4211register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4212@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4213the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4214used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4215stack.
4216@end defmac
4217
4218@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4219This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4220as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4221arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4222to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4223AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4224registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4225point register.
4226
4227The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4228false.
4229@end deftypefn
4230
4231@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4232This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4233The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4234@end deftypefn
4235
07a5b2bc 4236@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4237This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4238to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4239variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4240to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4241variable.
07a5b2bc 4242The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4243this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4244internal type.
4245If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4246Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4247macro to iterate through all types.
4248@end deftypefn
4249
4250@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4251This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4252@var{fndecl}.
4253The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4254@end deftypefn
4255
4256@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4257This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4258type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4259@code{NULL_TREE}.
4260@end deftypefn
4261
4262@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4263This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4264@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4265arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4266@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4267@end deftypefn
4268
4269@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4270Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4271with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4272hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4273@end deftypefn
4274
4275@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4276Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4277insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4278considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4279must work.
4280
4281The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4282required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4283Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4284code in @file{optabs.c}.
4285@end deftypefn
4286
4287@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4288Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4289insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4290must have move patterns for this mode.
4291@end deftypefn
4292
4293@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4294Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4295small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4296@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4297in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4298In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4299for any mode.
4300
4301On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4302insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4303to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4304if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4305insn.
4306
4307Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4308in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4309the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4310classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4311registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4312registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4313SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4314strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4315machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4316
4317The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4318safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4319unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4320that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4321to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4322of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4323@end deftypefn
4324
4325@node Scalar Return
4326@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4327@cindex return values in registers
4328@cindex values, returned by functions
4329@cindex scalars, returned as values
4330
4331This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4332values---values that can fit in registers.
4333
4334@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4335
4336Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4337returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4338representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4339representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4340function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4341compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4342Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4343a function returns a value.
4344
4345On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4346(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4347place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4348@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4349The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4350multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4351@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4352location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4353the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4354that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4355port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4356@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4357
4358If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4359the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4360@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4361
4362If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4363node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4364pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4365convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4366known.
4367
4368Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4369which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4370the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4371different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4372
4373@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4374aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4375@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4376@end deftypefn
4377
4378@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4379This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4380a new target instead.
4381@end defmac
4382
4383@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4384A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4385function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4386
4387Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4388support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4389specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4390compiled.
4391@end defmac
4392
4393@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4394Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4395function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4396
4397The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4398library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4399representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4400
4401If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4402@end deftypefn
4403
4404@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4405A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4406register in which the values of called function may come back.
4407
4408A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4409second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4410recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4411suffices:
4412
4413@smallexample
4414#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4415@end smallexample
4416
4417If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4418function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4419should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4420
4421This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4422for a new target instead.
4423@end defmac
4424
4425@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4426A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4427register in which the values of called function may come back.
4428
4429A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4430second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4431recognized by this target hook.
4432
4433If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4434function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4435should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4436
4437If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4438@end deftypefn
4439
4440@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4441Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4442need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4443saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4444@end defmac
4445
4446@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4447This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4448at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4449padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4450is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4451
4452Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4453be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4454or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44554-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4456@code{SImode} rtx.
4457@end deftypefn
4458
4459@node Aggregate Return
4460@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4461@cindex aggregates as return values
4462@cindex large return values
4463@cindex returning aggregate values
4464@cindex structure value address
4465
4466When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4467cases), the value is not returned according to
4468@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4469caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4470should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4471address}.
4472
4473This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4474memory.
4475
4476@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4477This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4478function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4479Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4480will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4481libcalls.
4482
4483Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4484by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4485takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4486possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4487definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4488values, and 0 otherwise.
4489
4490Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4491be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4492to indicate this.
4493@end deftypefn
4494
4495@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4496Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4497in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4498only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4499If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4500and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4501target hook.
4502
4503If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4504@end defmac
4505
4506@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4507This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4508address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4509passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4510be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4511hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4512argument.
4513
4514On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4515is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4516caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4517be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4518@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4519the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4520the caller.
4521
4522If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4523stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4524@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4525structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4526to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4527@end deftypefn
4528
4529@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4530Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4531for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4532the address of a static variable containing the value.
4533
4534Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4535pass an address to the subroutine.
4536
4537This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4538nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4539@end defmac
4540
ffa88471
SE
4541@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4542
4543@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4544
38f8b050
JR
4545@node Caller Saves
4546@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4547
4548If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4549makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4550must live across calls.
4551
4552@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4553A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4554a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4555restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4556this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4557
4558If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4559machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4560@end defmac
4561
4562@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4563A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4564of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4565@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4566returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4567will select the smallest suitable mode.
4568@end defmac
4569
4570@node Function Entry
4571@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4572@cindex function entry and exit
4573@cindex prologue
4574@cindex epilogue
4575
4576This section describes the macros that output function entry
4577(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4578
4579@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4580If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4581function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4582initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4583saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4584local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4585stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4586
4587The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4588macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4589
4590@findex regs_ever_live
4591To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4592@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4593@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4594prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4595call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4596@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4597
4598On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4599not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4600they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4601appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4602registers are used in the function.
4603
4604@findex frame_pointer_needed
4605On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4606function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4607pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4608frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4609@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4610time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4611
4612The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4613required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4614listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4615order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4616stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4617the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4618for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4619compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4620or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4621need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4622@end deftypefn
4623
4624@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4625If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4626prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4627emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4628emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4629@end deftypefn
4630
4631@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4632If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4633epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4634emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4635emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4636@end deftypefn
4637
4638@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4639If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4640function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4641registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4642called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4643same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4644registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4645@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4646
4647On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4648of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4649instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4650@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4651
4652Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4653@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4654switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4655define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4656target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4657condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4658
4659On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4660function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4661two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4662is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4663@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4664a function that needs a frame pointer.
4665
4666Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4667@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4668The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4669function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4670
4671On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4672others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4673given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4674number of arguments.
4675
4676@findex current_function_pops_args
4677Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4678functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4679needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4680function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4681@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4682@end deftypefn
4683
4684@itemize @bullet
4685@item
4686@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4687A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4688uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4689stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4690if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4691arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4692yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4693region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4694registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4695features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4696
4697@item
4698An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4699The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4700the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4701machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4702in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4703a save area.
4704
4705@item
4706A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4707boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4708this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4709save area closer to the top of the stack.
4710
4711@item
4712@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4713Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4714@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4715argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4716@end itemize
4717
4718@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4719Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4720instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4721pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4722adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4723default is 0.
4724
4725Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4726frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4727stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4728compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4729@end defmac
4730
4731@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4732Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4733used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4734pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4735@end defmac
4736
4737@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4738Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4739used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4740on entry to an exception edge.
4741@end defmac
4742
4743@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4744Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4745instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4746definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4747representing the number of delay slots there.
4748@end defmac
4749
4750@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4751A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4752slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4753
4754The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4755being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4756eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4757of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4758If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4759may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4760(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4761slot.
4762
4763@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4764@findex final_scan_insn
4765The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4766list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4767@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4768delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4769@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4770outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4771@code{final_scan_insn}.
4772
4773You need not define this macro if you did not define
4774@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4775@end defmac
4776
4777@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4778A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4779function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4780inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4781adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4782the real function.
4783
4784First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4785contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4786contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4787in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4788e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4789all other incoming arguments.
4790
4791Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4792made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4793adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4794
4795@smallexample
4796p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4797@end smallexample
4798
4799After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4800@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4801not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4802return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4803
4804The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4805the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4806of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4807and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4808
4809The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4810have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4811some targets, but probably not.
4812
4813If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4814front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4815@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4816not support varargs.
4817@end deftypefn
4818
4819@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4820A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4821to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4822arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4823generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4824previously exposed.
4825@end deftypefn
4826
4827@node Profiling
4828@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4829@cindex profiling, code generation
4830
4831These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4832
4833@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4834A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4835assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4836
4837@findex mcount
4838The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4839your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4840compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4841compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4842
4843Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4844variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4845@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4846the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4847@end defmac
4848
4849@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4850A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4851code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4852not support profiling.
4853@end defmac
4854
4855@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4856Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4857@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4858allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4859implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4860@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4861@end defmac
4862
4863@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4864Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4865the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4866@end defmac
4867
4868@node Tail Calls
4869@subsection Permitting tail calls
4870@cindex tail calls
4871
4872@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4873True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4874call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4875or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4876
4877It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4878tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4879during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4880as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4881``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4882may vary greatly between different architectures.
4883@end deftypefn
4884
4885@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4886Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4887function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4888cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4889registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4890TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4891FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4892@end deftypefn
4893
4894@node Stack Smashing Protection
4895@subsection Stack smashing protection
4896@cindex stack smashing protection
4897
4898@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4899This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4900for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4901runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4902that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4903variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4904
4905The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4906@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4907@end deftypefn
4908
4909@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4910This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4911stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4912involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4913
4914The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4915@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4916normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4917@end deftypefn
4918
7458026b
ILT
4919@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4920
38f8b050
JR
4921@node Varargs
4922@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4923@cindex varargs implementation
4924
4925GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4926@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4927on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4928varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4929conditionals to include it.
4930
4931ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4932the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4933implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4934to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4935@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4936supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4937
4938However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4939the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4940below.
4941
4942@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4943Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4944that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4945versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4946you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4947
4948On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4949control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4950other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4951found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4952
4953Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4954beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4955@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4956This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4957to use them for its own purposes.
4958@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4959@c 10feb93
4960@end defmac
4961
38f8b050 4962@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4963This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
4964argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4965returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4966argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4967fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4968verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4969of the current function.
4970@end defmac
4971
4972@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4973Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4974passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4975has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4976specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4977with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4978
4979@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4980considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4981kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4982
4983The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4984interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4985@end defmac
4986
4987These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4988
4989@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
4990If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4991@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4992beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4993return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4994to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4995@end deftypefn
4996
4997@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
4998This target hook offers an alternative to using
4999@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5000@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5001register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5002have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5003use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5004pass all their arguments on the stack.
5005
5006The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5007structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5008named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5009last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5010
5011The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5012argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5013store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5014variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5015store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5016frame.
5017
5018Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5019compile time without knowing their data types,
5020@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5021have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5022for all data types.
5023
5024If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5025arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5026happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5027end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5028not generate any instructions in this case.
5029@end deftypefn
5030
5031@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5032Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5033argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5034
5035This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5036is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5037@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5038arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5039but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5040then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5041except the last are treated as named.
5042
5043You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5044@end deftypefn
5045
5046@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5047If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5048@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5049@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5050defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5051@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5052Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5053@end deftypefn
5054
5055@node Trampolines
5056@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5057@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5058@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5059
5060A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5061when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5062the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5063tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5064trampoline.
5065
5066The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5067address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5068the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5069two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5070exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5071machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5072two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5073operands.
5074
5075The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5076parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5077immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5078simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5079proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5080may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5081separately.
5082
5083@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5084This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5085on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5086the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5087label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5088
5089If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5090for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5091code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5092to generate it on the spot.
5093@end deftypefn
5094
5095@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5096Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5097(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5098@end defmac
5099
5100@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5101A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5102@end defmac
5103
5104@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5105Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5106
5107If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5108is used for aligning trampolines.
5109@end defmac
5110
5111@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5112This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5113@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5114is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5115RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5116when it is called.
5117
5118If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5119first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5120from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5121Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5122trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5123to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5124
5125If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5126enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5127initializing the trampoline proper.
5128@end deftypefn
5129
5130@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5131This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5132the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5133memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5134the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5135address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5136be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5137If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5138@end deftypefn
5139
5140Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5141separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5142fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5143jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5144
5145Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5146the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5147make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5148subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5149latter makes initialization faster.
5150
5151To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5152the following macro.
5153
5154@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5155If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5156cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5157typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5158@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5159@end defmac
5160
5161The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5162before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5163the following macro.
5164
5165@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5166Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5167code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5168file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5169named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5170emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5171@code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5172@end defmac
5173
5174To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5175you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5176cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5177beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5178its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5179
5180@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5181Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5182work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5183which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5184@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5185
5186If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5187C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5188special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5189statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5190global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5191special assembler code.
5192@end defmac
5193
5194@node Library Calls
5195@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5196@cindex library subroutine names
5197@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5198
5199@c prevent bad page break with this line
5200Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5201
5202@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5203This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5204expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5205provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5206are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5207@end defmac
5208
5209@findex set_optab_libfunc
5210@findex init_one_libfunc
5211@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5212This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5213existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5214@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5215@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5216library routines.
5217
5218The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5219@end deftypefn
5220
5221@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5222This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5223implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5224mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5225return a tristate.
5226
5227GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5228comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5229don't need to define this macro.
5230@end defmac
5231
5232@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5233This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5234functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5235operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5236and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5237If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5238@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5239in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5240@end defmac
5241
5242@cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5243@cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5244@cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5245@findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5246@defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5247Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
5248library to provide floating point emulation.
5249
5250In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5251@code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5252else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5253in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5254architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5255an example.
5256
5257If this macro is defined, the
5258@code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5259false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
5260@end defmac
5261
5262@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5263@findex matherr
5264@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5265The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5266expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5267deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5268@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5269system.
5270
5271If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5272domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5273error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5274there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5275that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5276@end defmac
5277
5278@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5279@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5280Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5281refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5282@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5283macro, a reasonable default is used.
5284@end defmac
5285
5286@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5287@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5288When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5289@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5290default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5291functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5292systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5293@end defmac
5294
5295@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5296@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5297When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5298and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5299default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5300@smallexample
5301void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5302void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5303void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5304@end smallexample
5305@end defmac
5306
5307@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5308Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5309the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5310involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5311at once to the method-lookup library function.
5312
5313The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5314to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5315@end defmac
5316
5317@node Addressing Modes
5318@section Addressing Modes
5319@cindex addressing modes
5320
5321@c prevent bad page break with this line
5322This is about addressing modes.
5323
5324@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5325@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5326@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5327@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5328A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5329pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5330@end defmac
5331
5332@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5333@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5334A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5335post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5336the size of the memory operand.
5337@end defmac
5338
5339@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5340@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5341A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5342post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5343@end defmac
5344
5345@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5346A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5347is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5348@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5349is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5350constant addresses are supported.
5351@end defmac
5352
5353@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5354@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5355accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5356known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5357expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5358@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5359@end defmac
5360
5361@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5362A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5363memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5364the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5365accept.
5366@end defmac
5367
5368@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5369A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5370address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5371
5372Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5373non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5374desired by the caller.
5375
5376The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5377that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5378considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5379kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5380must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5381up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5382register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5383if the array holds @code{-1}.
5384
5385The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5386accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5387register is required.
5388
5389Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5390and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5391constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5392specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5393recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5394
5395Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5396sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5397@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5398naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5399be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5400
5401@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5402On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5403the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5404target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5405into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5406@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5407@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5408Format}.
5409
5410@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5411Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5412this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5413has this syntax:
5414
5415@example
5416#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5417@end example
5418
5419@noindent
5420and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5421address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5422
5423@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5424Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5425macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5426@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5427that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5428
38f8b050
JR
5429Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5430files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5431@end deftypefn
5432
5433@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5434A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5435character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5436letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5437@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5438support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5439semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5440preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5441@code{'m'} constraint.
5442@end defmac
5443
5444@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5445A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5446or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5447can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5448@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5449
5450It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5451that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5452
5453The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5454a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5455@end defmac
5456
5457@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5458This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5459operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5460address.
5461
5462@findex break_out_memory_refs
5463@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5464and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5465@var{x}.
5466
5467The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5468@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5469should return the new @var{x}.
5470
5471It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5472The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5473is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5474a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5475strategy can generate better code.
5476@end deftypefn
5477
5478@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5479A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5480that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5481@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5482It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5483performance reasons.
5484
5485For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5486reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5487registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5488processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5489needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5490@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5491generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5492be shared.
5493
5494@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5495to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5496and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5497of reload internals.
5498
5499@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5500previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5501then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5502
5503@findex push_reload
5504The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5505need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5506suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5507
5508The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5509@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5510should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5511This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5512@code{push_reload}.
5513
5514@findex strict_memory_address_p
5515The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5516the address has become legitimate.
5517
5518@findex copy_rtx
5519If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5520this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5521single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5522top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5523It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5524address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5525@end defmac
5526
5527@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5528This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5529different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5530reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5531but not others.
5532
5533Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5534effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5535of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5536addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5537
5538You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5539
5540The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5541@end deftypefn
5542
5543@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5544A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5545@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5546different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5547reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5548but not others.
5549
5550Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5551effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5552of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5553addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5554
5555You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5556
5557These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5558@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5559@end defmac
5560
5561@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5562A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5563an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5564@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5565@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5566anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5567@end defmac
5568
5569@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5570This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5571@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5572macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5573references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5574addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5575the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5576into their original form.
5577@end deftypefn
5578
5579@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5580This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5581should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5582this hook returns false.
5583
5584The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5585deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5586from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5587holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5588of TLS symbols for various targets.
5589@end deftypefn
5590
5591@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5592This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5593be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5594of @var{x}.
5595
5596The default version returns false for all constants.
5597@end deftypefn
5598
89356d17 5599@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5600This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5601the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5602@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5603when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5604@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5605of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5606function are valid.
5607@end deftypefn
5608
5609@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5610This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5611address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5612used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5613@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5614
5615The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5616@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5617the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5618@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5619two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5620@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5621the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5622from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5623@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5624@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5625@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5626
5627If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5628to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5629use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5630@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5631should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5632described above.
5633If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5634the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5635log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5636@end deftypefn
5637
5638@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5639This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5640widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5641
5642If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5643@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5644widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5645preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5646@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5647@end deftypefn
5648
5649@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5650This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5651widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5652
5653If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5654@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5655widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5656preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5657@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5658@end deftypefn
5659
5660@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5661Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
720f5239
IR
5662For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5663misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5664@end deftypefn
5665
5666@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5667Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5668@end deftypefn
5669
5670@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5671Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5672@end deftypefn
5673
5674@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5675Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5676@end deftypefn
5677
5678@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5679This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5680input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5681The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5682specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5683(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5684
5685If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5686@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5687conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5688@end deftypefn
5689
5690@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5691This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5692vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5693@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5694The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5695return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5696@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5697@end deftypefn
5698
5699@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5700This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5701store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5702parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5703the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5704parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5705@end deftypefn
5706
cc4b5170
RG
5707@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5708This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5709mode @var{mode}. The default is
5710equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5711transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5712@end deftypefn
5713
767f865f
RG
5714@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5715This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5716after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5717mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5718The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5719@end deftypefn
5720
38f8b050
JR
5721@node Anchored Addresses
5722@section Anchored Addresses
5723@cindex anchored addresses
5724@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5725
5726GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5727For example, if we have:
5728
5729@smallexample
5730static int a, b, c;
5731int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5732@end smallexample
5733
5734the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5735addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5736it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5737the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5738be something like:
5739
5740@smallexample
5741int foo (void)
5742@{
5743 register int *xr = &x;
5744 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5745@}
5746@end smallexample
5747
5748(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5749``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5750
5751The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5752in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5753section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5754or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5755
5756@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5757The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5758On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5759applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5760for every mode. The default value is 0.
5761@end deftypevr
5762
5763@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5764Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5765offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5766value is 0.
5767@end deftypevr
5768
5769@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5770Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5771@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5772The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5773of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5774
5775If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5776it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5777If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5778is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5779@end deftypefn
5780
5781@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5782Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5783@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5784@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5785
5786The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5787intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5788or target-specific sections.
5789@end deftypefn
5790
5791@node Condition Code
5792@section Condition Code Status
5793@cindex condition code status
5794
5795The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5796two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5797
5798The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5799(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5800clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5801register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5802architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5803most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5804most RISC machines.
5805
5806The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5807the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5808insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5809optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5810is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5811three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5812scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5813separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5814
5815For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5816represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5817condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5818condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5819or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5820Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5821that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5822
5823Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5824specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5825interested in most macros in this section.
5826
5827@menu
5828* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5829* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5830* Cond. Exec. Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5831@end menu
5832
5833@node CC0 Condition Codes
5834@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5835@findex cc0
5836
5837@findex cc_status
5838The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5839describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5840the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5841variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5842currently based, and several standard flags.
5843
5844Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5845description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5846information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5847
5848@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5849C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5850component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5851
5852This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5853@end defmac
5854
5855@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5856A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5857The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5858the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5859define this macro to initialize it.
5860
5861This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5862@end defmac
5863
5864@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5865A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5866appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5867this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5868code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5869set @code{(cc0)}.
5870
5871This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5872
5873If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5874other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5875invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5876reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5877registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5878@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5879insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5880based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5881value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5882this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5883@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5884@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5885condition code value.
5886
5887The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5888with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5889@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5890constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5891insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5892@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5893@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5894
5895A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5896that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5897@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5898two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5899@end defmac
5900
5901@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5902@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5903@findex CCmode
5904@findex MODE_CC
5905
5906@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5907On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5908than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5909code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5910when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5911bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5912branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5913this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5914record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5915also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5916unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5917
5918If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5919@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5920a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5921have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5922by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5923be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5924the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5925
5926@smallexample
5927(define_insn ""
5928 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5929 (compare:CC_NOOV
5930 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5931 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5932 (const_int 0)))]
5933 ""
5934 "@dots{}")
5935@end smallexample
5936
5937@noindent
5938together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5939for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5940
5941@smallexample
5942#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5943 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5944 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5945 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5946 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5947 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5948@end smallexample
5949
5950Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5951were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5952this section.
5953
5954You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5955in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5956@end defmac
5957
5958@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5959On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5960convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5961does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5962comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5963
5964On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5965required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5966and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5967comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5968@var{op1} as required.
5969
5970GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5971valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5972@file{md} file.
5973
5974You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5975code or operands.
5976@end defmac
5977
5978@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5979A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5980comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5981can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5982then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5983
5984You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5985floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5986For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5987inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5988
5989@smallexample
5990#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5991@end smallexample
5992@end defmac
5993
5994@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5995A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
5996comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
5997@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
5998machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
5999instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6000freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6001like:
6002
6003@smallexample
6004#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6005 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6006 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6007@end smallexample
6008@end defmac
6009
6010@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6011On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6012register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6013regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6014hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6015small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6016to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6017arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6018When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6019integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6020@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6021
6022The default version of this hook returns false.
6023@end deftypefn
6024
6025@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6026On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6027@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6028validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6029target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6030both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6031return @code{VOIDmode}.
6032
6033The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6034same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6035returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6036@end deftypefn
6037
6038@node Cond. Exec. Macros
6039@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6040@findex conditional execution
6041@findex predication
6042
6043There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6044supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6045represent conditional branches.
6046
6047@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6048A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6049@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6050versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6051predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6052that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6053If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6054
6055@smallexample
6056#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6057 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6058@end smallexample
6059@end defmac
6060
6061@node Costs
6062@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6063@cindex costs of instructions
6064@cindex relative costs
6065@cindex speed of instructions
6066
6067These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6068on the target machine.
6069
6070@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6071A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6072register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6073expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6074value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6075that.
6076
6077It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6078same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6079registers if they are not general registers.
6080
6081If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6082hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6083classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6084constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6085allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6086if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6087
6088These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6089@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6090@end defmac
6091
6092@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6093This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6094from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6095are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6096A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6097that.
6098
6099It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6100same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6101registers if they are not general registers.
6102
6103If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6104hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6105classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6106constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6107allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6108if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6109
6110The default version of this function returns 2.
6111@end deftypefn
6112
6113@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6114A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6115register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6116is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6117is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6118registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6119should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6120
6121If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6122the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6123needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6124between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6125more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6126reflect the actual cost of the move.
6127
6128GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6129secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6130a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6131secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61324 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6133value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6134are the same as to this macro.
6135
6136These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6137@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6138@end defmac
6139
911852ff 6140@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6141This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6142between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6143if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6144This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6145If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6146registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6147
6148If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6149the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6150needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6151between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6152more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6153reflect the actual cost of the move.
6154
6155GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6156secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6157a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6158secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61594 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6160value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6161are the same as to this target hook.
6162@end deftypefn
6163
6164@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6165A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6166default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6167is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6168it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6169rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6170predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6171reduced then.
6172@end defmac
6173
6174Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6175but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6176ordinarily expect.
6177
6178@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6179Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6180than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6181faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6182require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6183between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6184
6185When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6186finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6187load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6188faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6189may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6190other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6191@end defmac
6192
6193@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6194Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6195@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6196than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6197handler.
6198
6199When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6200@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6201moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6202Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6203cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6204
6205If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6206this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6207@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6208@end defmac
6209
6210@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6211The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6212which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6213string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6214make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6215
6216Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6217@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6218the number of such sequences.
6219
6220The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6221optimized for speed rather than size.
6222
6223If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6224@end defmac
6225
6226@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6227A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6228copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6229will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6230than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6231@end defmac
6232
6233@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6234A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6235a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6236@end defmac
6237
6238@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6239The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6240of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6241or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6242eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6243
6244The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6245optimized for speed rather than size.
6246
6247If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6248@end defmac
6249
6250@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6251A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6252to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6253will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6254than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6255@end defmac
6256
6257@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6258The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6259of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6260a block set insn or a library call.
6261Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6262eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6263
6264The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6265optimized for speed rather than size.
6266
6267If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6268@end defmac
6269
6270@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6271A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6272used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6273other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6274storing values other than constant zero.
6275Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6276than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6277@end defmac
6278
6279@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6280A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6281used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6282other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6283called with a constant source string.
6284Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6285than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6286@end defmac
6287
6288@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6289A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6290thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6291@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6292@end defmac
6293
6294@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6295A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6296thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6297@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6298@end defmac
6299
6300@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6301A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6302thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6303@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6304@end defmac
6305
6306@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6307A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6308thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6309@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6310@end defmac
6311
6312@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6313A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6314thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6315@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6316@end defmac
6317
6318@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6319A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6320thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6321@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6322@end defmac
6323
6324@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6325This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6326thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6327@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6328@end defmac
6329
6330@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6331This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6332thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6333@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6334@end defmac
6335
6336@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6337Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6338function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6339@end defmac
6340
6341@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6342Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6343@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6344@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6345@end defmac
6346
6347@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6348This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6349
6350The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6351available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6352in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6353expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6354@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6355
6356In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6357@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6358instructions.
6359
6360On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6361for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6362necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6363for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6364operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6365
6366When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6367false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6368size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6369
6370The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6371processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6372@end deftypefn
6373
6374@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6375This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6376@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6377the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6378
6379For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6380true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6381instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6382all addresses will have equal costs.
6383
6384In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6385the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6386cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6387
6388For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6389and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6390is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6391references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6392the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6393that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6394instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6395specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6396
6397This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6398
6399On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6400cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6401@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6402be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6403@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6404should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6405should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6406registers on machines with lots of registers.
6407@end deftypefn
6408
6409@node Scheduling
6410@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6411
6412The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6413adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6414hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6415them: try the first ones in this list first.
6416
6417@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6418This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6419issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6420Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6421an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6422constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6423hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6424This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6425it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6426@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6427@end deftypefn
6428
6429@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6430This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6431from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6432still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6433@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6434@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6435You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6436than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6437@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6438debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6439@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6440was scheduled.
6441@end deftypefn
6442
6443@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6444This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6445relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6446dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6447is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6448to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6449that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6450data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6451description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6452output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6453times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6454acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6455@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6456@end deftypefn
6457
6458@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6459This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6460@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6461execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6462later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6463scheduling priorities of insns.
6464@end deftypefn
6465
6466@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6467This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6468list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6469combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6470@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6471debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6472@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6473list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6474a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6475reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6476@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6477is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6478the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6479can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6480@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6481@end deftypefn
6482
6483@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6484Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6485function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6486is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6487@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6488return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6489this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6490scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6491cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6492@end deftypefn
6493
6494@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6495This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6496chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6497correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6498example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6499analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6500dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6501calculated.
6502@end deftypefn
6503
6504@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6505This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6506instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6507pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6508is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6509@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6510region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6511scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6512@end deftypefn
6513
6514@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6515This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6516instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6517cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6518is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6519to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6520@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6521@end deftypefn
6522
6523@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6524This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6525@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6526@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6527@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6528@end deftypefn
6529
6530@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6531This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6532@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6533@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6534@end deftypefn
6535
6536@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6537The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6538pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6539when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6540simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6541processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6542based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6543when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6544@end deftypefn
6545
6546@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6547The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6548@end deftypefn
6549
6550@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6551The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6552to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6553simulated processor cycle finishes.
6554@end deftypefn
6555
6556@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6557The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6558used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6559@end deftypefn
6560
6561@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6562The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6563The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6564to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6565state on a single insn is not enough.
6566@end deftypefn
6567
6568@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6569The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6570The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6571to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6572state on a single insn is not enough.
6573@end deftypefn
6574
6575@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6576This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6577for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6578chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6579value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6580@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6581subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6582maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6583@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6584packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6585rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6586
6587This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6588processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6589with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6590@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6591@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6592processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6593@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6594until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6595the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6596
6597Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6598pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6599schedules to choose the best one.
6600
6601The default is no multipass scheduling.
6602@end deftypefn
6603
6604@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6605
6606This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6607considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6608zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6609be issued.
6610
6611The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6612@end deftypefn
6613
894fd6f2
MK
6614@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6615This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6616scheduling.
6617@end deftypefn
6618
6619@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6620This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6621@end deftypefn
6622
6623@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6624This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6625an instruction.
6626@end deftypefn
6627
6628@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6629This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6630round of multipass scheduling.
6631@end deftypefn
6632
6633@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
6634This hook initilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6635@end deftypefn
6636
6637@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
6638This hook finilizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6639@end deftypefn
6640
c06bbdf7 6641@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6642This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6643on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6644@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6645the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6646is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6647start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6648verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6649@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6650processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6651and the current processor cycle.
6652@end deftypefn
6653
6654@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6655This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6656the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6657are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6658to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6659being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6660dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6661parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6662The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6663insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6664and @code{false} otherwise.
6665
6666Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6667where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6668delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6669that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6670important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6671closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6672not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6673@end deftypefn
6674
6675@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6676This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6677the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6678per instruction data structures.
6679@end deftypefn
6680
6681@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6682Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6683@end deftypefn
6684
6685@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6686Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6687It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6688beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6689@end deftypefn
6690
6691@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6692Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6693@end deftypefn
6694
6695@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6696Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6697@end deftypefn
6698
6699@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6700Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6701@end deftypefn
6702
6703@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6704This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6705speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6706The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6707version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6708pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6709or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6710speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6711the generated speculative pattern.
6712@end deftypefn
6713
6714@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6715This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6716for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6717instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6718@end deftypefn
6719
6720@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6721This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6722check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6723speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6724@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6725be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6726recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6727a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6728@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6729@end deftypefn
6730
6731@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6732This hook is used as a workaround for
6733@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6734called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6735discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6736being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6737@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6738For non-speculative instructions,
6739the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6740the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6741is nearly full.
6742@end deftypefn
6743
6744@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6745This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6746enabled/used.
6747The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6748The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6749@end deftypefn
6750
6751@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6752This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6753resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6754the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6755backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6756bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6757of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6758@end deftypefn
6759
7942e47e
RY
6760@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6761This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6762is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6763@end deftypefn
6764
6765@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6766This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6767in its second parameter.
6768@end deftypefn
6769
38f8b050
JR
6770@node Sections
6771@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6772@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6773@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6774
6775An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6776data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6777section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6778section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6779section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6780of sections.
6781
6782@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6783@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6784The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6785is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6786as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6787initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6788They may however depend on command-line flags.
6789
6790@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6791use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6792to be string literals.
6793
6794Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6795section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6796should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6797@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6798
6799You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6800@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6801in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6802@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6803create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6804reuse @code{text_section}.
6805
6806All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6807if the target does not provide them.
6808
6809@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6810A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6811assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6812Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6813@end defmac
6814
6815@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6816If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6817frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6818a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6819@end defmac
6820
6821@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6822If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6823executed functions in the program.
6824@end defmac
6825
6826@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6827A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6828assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6829data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6830@end defmac
6831
6832@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6833If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6834containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6835initialized, writable small data.
6836@end defmac
6837
6838@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6839A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6840assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6841data.
6842@end defmac
6843
6844@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6845If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6846containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6847uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6848@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6849uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6850@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6851used.
6852@end defmac
6853
6854@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6855If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6856containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6857uninitialized, writable small data.
6858@end defmac
6859
6860@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6861If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6862assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6863common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6864@end defmac
6865
6866@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6867If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6868containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6869default is @code{'T'}.
6870@end defmac
6871
6872@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6873If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6874containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6875initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6876not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6877variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6878@end defmac
6879
6880@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6881If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6882containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6883finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6884not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6885variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6886@end defmac
6887
6888@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6889If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6890containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6891part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6892defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6893both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6894@end defmac
6895
6896@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6897If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6898containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6899part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6900defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6901both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6902@end defmac
6903
6904@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6905If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6906via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6907the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6908@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6909to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6910sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6911ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6912registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6913constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6914@end defmac
6915
6916@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6917If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6918variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6919when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6920you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6921they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6922expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6923MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6924require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6925to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6926access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6927@end defmac
6928
6929@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6930If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6931arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6932@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6933and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6934@end defmac
6935
6936@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6937Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6938tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6939section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6940readonly data section is used.
6941
6942This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6943@end defmac
6944
6945@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6946Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6947@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6948of its own that you need to create.
6949
6950GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6951any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6952described below.
6953@end deftypefn
6954
6955@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6956Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6957selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6958should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6959local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6960
6961The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6962is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6963when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6964in read-only sections even in executables.
6965@end deftypefn
6966
6967@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6968Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6969assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6970some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6971requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6972local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6973@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6974
6975The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6976variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6977
6978See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6979@end deftypefn
6980
6981@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6982Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6983for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6984
6985In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6986function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6987it is unlikely to be called.
6988@end defmac
6989
6990@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6991Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6992and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6993As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6994the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6995
6996The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6997ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6998example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6999Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7000@end deftypefn
7001
7002@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7003Return the readonly data section associated with
7004@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7005The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7006the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7007if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7008otherwise.
7009@end deftypefn
7010
7011@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7012Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7013should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7014constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7015case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7016in bits.
7017
7018The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7019constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7020else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7021@end deftypefn
7022
7023@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7024Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7025by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7026the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7027or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7028hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7029your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7030returns the @var{id} provided.
7031@end deftypefn
7032
7033@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7034Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7035treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7036function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7037
7038The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7039@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7040an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7041rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7042in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7043
7044In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7045a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7046will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7047register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7048rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7049leave it alone.)
7050
7051The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7052that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7053be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7054declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7055declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7056@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7057
7058@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7059The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7060@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7061Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7062encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7063discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7064
7065The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7066in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7067@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7068before overriding it.
7069@end deftypefn
7070
7071@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7072Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7073the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7074may have added.
7075@end deftypefn
7076
7077@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7078Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7079The default version of this hook always returns false.
7080@end deftypefn
7081
7082@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7083Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7084``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7085@end deftypevr
7086
3c5273a9
KT
7087@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7088
38f8b050
JR
7089@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7090Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7091rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7092or executable image).
7093
7094The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7095for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7096currently supported object file formats.
7097@end deftypefn
7098
7099@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7100Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7101The default value is false.
7102@end deftypevr
7103
7104
7105@node PIC
7106@section Position Independent Code
7107@cindex position independent code
7108@cindex PIC
7109
7110This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7111independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7112generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7113@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7114@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7115must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7116when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7117need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7118relative addresses.
7119@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7120@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7121
7122@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7123The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7124data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7125processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7126is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7127pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7128is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7129necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7130when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7131@end defmac
7132
7133@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7134A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7135@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7136the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7137this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7138@end defmac
7139
7140@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7141A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7142operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7143You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7144check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7145check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7146(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7147position independent code.
7148@end defmac
7149
7150@node Assembler Format
7151@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7152
7153This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7154to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7155instructions do.
7156
7157@menu
7158* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7159* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7160* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7161* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7162* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7163 and termination routines.
7164* Macros for Initialization::
7165 Specific macros that control the handling of
7166 initialization and termination routines.
7167* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7168* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7169* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7170* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7171@end menu
7172
7173@node File Framework
7174@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7175@cindex assembler format
7176@cindex output of assembler code
7177
7178@c prevent bad page break with this line
7179This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7180
7181@findex default_file_start
7182@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7183Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7184find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7185by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7186quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7187@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7188lets other target files rely on these variables.
7189@end deftypefn
7190
7191@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7192If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7193printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7194@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7195to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7196definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7197assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7198whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7199
7200The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7201verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7202comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7203@end deftypevr
7204
7205@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7206If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7207for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7208@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7209this to be done. The default is false.
7210@end deftypevr
7211
7212@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7213Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7214to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7215@end deftypefn
7216
7217@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7218Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7219special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7220the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7221should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7222need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7223this function.
7224@end deftypefun
7225
7226@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7227Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7228to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7229nothing.
7230@end deftypefn
7231
7232@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7233Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7234to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7235nothing.
7236@end deftypefn
7237
7238@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7239Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7240unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7241here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7242because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7243nothing.
7244@end deftypefn
7245
7246@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7247A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7248assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7249the end of the line.
7250@end defmac
7251
7252@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7253A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7254statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7255@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7256assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7257that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7258@end defmac
7259
7260@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7261A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7262statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7263@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7264time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7265@end defmac
7266
7267@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7268A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7269which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7270the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7271
7272This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7273for the file format in use is appropriate.
7274@end defmac
7275
b5f5d41d
AS
7276@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7277
38f8b050
JR
7278@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7279A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7280@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7281in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7282the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7283of the filename using this macro.
7284@end defmac
7285
7286@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7287A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7288@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7289macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7290@end defmac
7291
7292@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7293Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7294should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7295of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7296is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7297this section is associated.
7298@end deftypefn
7299
7300@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7301This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7302@end deftypevr
7303
7304@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7305@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7306This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7307section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7308This is true on most ELF targets.
7309@end deftypevr
7310
7311@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7312Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7313based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7314declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7315null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7316
7317The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7318read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7319need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7320set via @code{__attribute__}.
7321@end deftypefn
7322
7323@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7324Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7325switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7326enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7327It can take the following values:
7328
7329@table @gcctabopt
7330@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7331@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7332
7333@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7334@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7335direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7336default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7337command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7338various different individual optimization passes.
7339
7340@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7341@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7342ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7343target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7344time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7345warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7346wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7347necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7348perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7349switches.
7350
7351@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7352This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7353
7354@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7355This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7356@end table
7357
7358The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7359supported in the future.
7360
7361By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7362provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7363it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7364section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7365provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7366hook.
7367@end deftypefn
7368
7369@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7370This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7371ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7372hook.
7373@end deftypevr
7374
7375@need 2000
7376@node Data Output
7377@subsection Output of Data
7378
7379
7380@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7381@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7382@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7383@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7384@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7385@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7386@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7387@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7388@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7389These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7390of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7391byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7392aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7393@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7394
7395The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7396followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7397the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7398@end deftypevr
7399
7400@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7401The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7402integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7403in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7404function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7405object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7406split the object into smaller parts.
7407
7408The default implementation of this hook will use the
7409@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7410when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7411@end deftypefn
7412
6cbd8875
AS
7413@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7414A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7415can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7416the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7417@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7418
7419If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7420so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7421itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7422return @code{true}.
7423@end deftypefn
7424
38f8b050
JR
7425@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7426A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7427@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7428@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7429allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7430
7431If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7432@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7433prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7434@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7435@end defmac
7436
7437@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7438A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7439instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7440bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7441@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7442
7443If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7444Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7445@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7446@end defmac
7447
7448@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7449A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7450@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7451is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7452@end defmac
7453
7454@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7455You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7456expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7457pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7458GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7459not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7460pool before the function.
7461@end defmac
7462
7463@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7464A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7465constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7466the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7467be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7468is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7469immediately after this call.
7470
7471If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7472not be defined.
7473@end defmac
7474
7475@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7476A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7477constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7478anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7479
7480The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7481assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7482output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7483@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7484@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7485alignment.
7486
7487The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7488the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7489responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7490Here is how to do this:
7491
7492@smallexample
7493@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7494@end smallexample
7495
7496When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7497@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7498entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7499
7500You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7501@end defmac
7502
7503@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7504A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7505pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7506function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7507obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7508constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7509
7510If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7511define this macro.
7512@end defmac
7513
7514@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7515Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7516used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7517to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7518a line separator uses multiple characters.
7519
7520If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7521the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7522@end defmac
7523
7524@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7525These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7526assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7527default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7528@end deftypevr
7529
7530These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7531of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7532
7533@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7534@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7535@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7536@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7537@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7538@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7539These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7540target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7541the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7542@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7543simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7544@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7545by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7546it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
754732 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7548on the host machine.
7549
7550The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7551using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7552machine's memory.
7553@end defmac
7554
7555@node Uninitialized Data
7556@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7557
7558Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7559outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7560
7561@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7562A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7563@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7564@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7565is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7566possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7567other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7568backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7569byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7570equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7571the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7572an ordinary undefined external.
7573
7574Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7575output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7576assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7577
7578This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7579common global variables are output.
7580@end defmac
7581
7582@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7583Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7584separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7585place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7586handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7587as the number of bits.
7588@end defmac
7589
7590@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7591Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7592variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7593is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7594in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7595@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7596the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7597@end defmac
7598
7599@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7600A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7601@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7602@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7603is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7604
7605Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7606defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7607@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7608before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7609the name, and a newline.
7610
7611There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
7612this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7613The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7614switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7615You do not need to do both.
7616
7617Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7618non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7619efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7620not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7621common in order to save space in the object file.
7622@end defmac
7623
7624@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7625Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7626separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7627place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7628handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7629as the number of bits.
7630
7631Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7632@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
7633@end defmac
7634
7635@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7636A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7637@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7638@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7639is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7640
7641Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7642output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7643assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7644
7645This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7646static variables are output.
7647@end defmac
7648
7649@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7650Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7651separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7652place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7653handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7654as the number of bits.
7655@end defmac
7656
7657@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7658Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7659variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7660is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7661in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7662@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7663the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7664@end defmac
7665
7666@node Label Output
7667@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7668
7669@c prevent bad page break with this line
7670This is about outputting labels.
7671
7672@findex assemble_name
7673@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7674A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7675@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7676Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7677output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7678assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7679definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7680@end defmac
7681
135a687e
KT
7682@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7683A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7684@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7685a function.
7686Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7687output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7688assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7689definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7690
7691If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7692usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7693@end defmac
7694
38f8b050
JR
7695@findex assemble_name_raw
7696@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7697Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7698to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7699@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7700that it is more efficient.
7701@end defmac
7702
7703@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7704A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7705size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7706default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7707systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7708
7709Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7710of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7711for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7712macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7713define this macro.
7714@end defmac
7715
7716@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7717A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7718@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7719symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7720If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7721provided.
7722@end defmac
7723
7724@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7725A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7726@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7727the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7728address.
7729
7730If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7731provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7732@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7733the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7734not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7735to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7736@end defmac
7737
7738@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7739A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7740type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7741default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7742systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7743
7744Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7745@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7746custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7747types at all, do not define this macro.
7748@end defmac
7749
7750@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7751A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7752the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7753default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7754the default is not to define this macro.
7755
7756Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7757@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7758custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7759types at all, do not define this macro.
7760@end defmac
7761
7762@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7763A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7764@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7765symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7766that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7767you should not count on this.
7768
7769If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7770definition of this macro is provided.
7771@end defmac
7772
7773@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7774A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7775@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7776function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7777outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7778@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7779@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7780
7781If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7782usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7783
7784You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7785of this macro.
7786@end defmac
7787
7788@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7789A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7790@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7791which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7792function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7793representing the function.
7794
7795If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7796
7797You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7798of this macro.
7799@end defmac
7800
7801@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7802A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7803@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7804initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7805label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7806@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7807
7808If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7809usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7810
7811You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7812@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7813@end defmac
7814
ad78130c 7815@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7816A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7817for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7818target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7819@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7820and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7821will be an internal label.
7822
7823The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7824usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7825
7826You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7827@end deftypefn
7828
7829@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7830A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7831@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7832for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7833
7834If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7835nothing.
7836@end defmac
7837
7838@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7839A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7840once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7841chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7842initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7843something about the size of the object.
7844
7845If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7846nothing.
7847
7848You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7849@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7850@end defmac
7851
7852@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7853This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7854@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7855that is, available for reference from other files.
7856
7857The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7858@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7859@end deftypefn
7860
7861@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7862This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7863@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7864global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7865
7866The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7867@end deftypefn
7868
7869@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7870A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7871@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7872that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7873no other definition is available. Use the expression
7874@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7875itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7876for making that name weak, and a newline.
7877
7878If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7879support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7880macro.
7881@end defmac
7882
7883@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7884Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7885@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7886or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7887should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7888defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7889@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7890to make @var{name} weak.
7891@end defmac
7892
7893@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7894Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7895symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7896declaration of @code{name}.
7897@end defmac
7898
7899@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7900A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7901supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7902
7903If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7904definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7905is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7906@end defmac
7907
7908@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7909A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7910
7911If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7912definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7913this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7914flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7915@end defmac
7916
7917@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7918A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7919public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7920be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7921format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7922section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7923requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7924@end defmac
7925
7926@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7927A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7928semantics.
7929
7930If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7931definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7932definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7933you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7934setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7935be emitted as one-only.
7936@end defmac
7937
7938@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7939This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7940commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7941hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7942@end deftypefn
7943
7944@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7945A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7946that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7947The default is @code{0}.
7948
7949Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7950if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7951will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7952symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7953thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7954(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7955with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7956
7957The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7958targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7959restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7960table of contents.
7961@end defmac
7962
7963@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7964A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7965@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7966symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7967not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7968declaration.
7969
7970This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7971The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7972@end defmac
7973
7974@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7975This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7976pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7977library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7978@end deftypefn
7979
7980@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7981This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7982directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7983.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7984@end deftypefn
7985
7986@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7987A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7988@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7989@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7990is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7991systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7992@end defmac
7993
7994@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7995A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7996@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7997will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7998to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7999encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8000@end defmac
8001
8002@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8003A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8004result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8005@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8006This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8007specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8008when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8009being taken.
8010@end defmac
8011
8012@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8013A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8014name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8015
8016It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8017used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8018will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8019
8020It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8021object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8022should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8023beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8024convention your system uses, and follow it.
8025
8026The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8027@end deftypefn
8028
8029@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8030A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8031label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8032@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8033may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8034systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8035bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8036bundles.
8037
8038If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8039used.
8040@end defmac
8041
8042@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8043A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8044is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8045
8046This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8047produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8048with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8049
8050If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8051output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8052@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8053string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8054to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8055@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8056you should know what it does on your machine.)
8057@end defmac
8058
8059@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8060A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8061@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8062@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8063added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8064
8065The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8066produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8067@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8068assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8069macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8070internal static variables in different scopes.
8071
8072Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8073conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8074or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8075between the name and the number will suffice.
8076
8077If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8078which is correct for most systems.
8079@end defmac
8080
8081@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8082A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8083which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8084
8085@findex SET_ASM_OP
8086If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8087correct for most systems.
8088@end defmac
8089
8090@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8091A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8092which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8093to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8094be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8095the tree nodes are available.
8096
8097@findex SET_ASM_OP
8098If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8099correct for most systems.
8100@end defmac
8101
8102@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8103A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8104(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8105of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8106current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8107This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8108@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8109@end defmac
8110
8111@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8112A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8113which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8114@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8115an undefined weak symbol.
8116
8117Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8118@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8119@end defmac
8120
8121@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8122Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8123Objective-C methods.
8124
8125The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8126class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8127the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8128@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8129
8130These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8131the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8132systems define other ways of computing names.
8133
8134@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8135buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8136@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
813750 characters extra.
8138
8139The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8140method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8141@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8142in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8143
8144On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8145macro to provide more human-readable names.
8146@end defmac
8147
8148@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8149A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8150@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8151Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8152linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8153@end defmac
8154
8155@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8156A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8157@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8158unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8159whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8160@end defmac
8161
8162@node Initialization
8163@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8164@cindex initialization routines
8165@cindex termination routines
8166@cindex constructors, output of
8167@cindex destructors, output of
8168
8169The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8170(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8171data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8172to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8173@code{main} is called.
8174
8175Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8176@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8177terminates.
8178
8179To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8180must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8181be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8182system, you need to specify how to do this.
8183
8184There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8185initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8186Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8187
8188@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8189@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8190The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8191initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8192termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8193
8194Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
81950, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8196the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8197pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8198pointer containing zero.
8199
8200Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8201@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8202time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8203list; destructors in forward order.
8204
8205The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8206formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8207aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8208Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8209object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8210the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8211accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8212Termination functions are handled similarly.
8213
8214This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8215@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8216support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8217constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8218and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8219
8220When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8221upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8222support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8223parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8224program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8225
8226@smallexample
8227ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8228@end smallexample
8229
8230The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8231section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8232for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8233files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8234are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8235
8236The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8237compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8238fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8239to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8240of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8241that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8242
8243To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8244macro properly.
8245
8246If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8247@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8248entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8249it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8250after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8251in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8252
8253In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8254two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8255and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8256@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8257entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8258and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8259code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8260the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8261placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8262a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8263@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8264section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8265the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8266the initialization process.
8267
8268The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8269This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8270file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8271this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8272termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8273an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8274pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8275the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8276initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8277via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8278@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8279
8280@ifinfo
8281The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8282customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8283@end ifinfo
8284
8285@node Macros for Initialization
8286@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8287
8288Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8289and termination functions:
8290
8291@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8292If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8293operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8294defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8295using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8296macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8297run the initialization functions.
8298@end defmac
8299
8300@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8301If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8302This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8303on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8304be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8305@end defmac
8306
8307@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8308If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8309the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8310@end defmac
8311
8312@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8313If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8314the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8315@end defmac
8316
8317@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8318If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8319automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8320should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8321the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8322function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8323
8324This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8325shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8326exception tables embedded in the code.
8327@end defmac
8328
8329@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8330If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8331automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8332should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8333the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8334function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8335@end defmac
8336
8337@defmac INVOKE__main
8338If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8339@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8340where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8341useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8342@end defmac
8343
8344@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8345If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8346compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8347of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8348encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8349@end defmac
8350
8351@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8352This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8353collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8354It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8355@end deftypevr
8356
8357@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8358If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8359the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8360
8361Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8362no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8363priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8364otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8365
8366If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8367be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8368target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8369is not defined.
8370@end deftypefn
8371
8372@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8373This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8374functions rather than initialization functions.
8375@end deftypefn
8376
8377If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8378generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8379
8380If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8381constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8382an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8383
8384On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8385@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8386
8387@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8388Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8389object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8390object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8391
8392This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8393part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8394@end defmac
8395
8396@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8397Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8398to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8399@command{nm}.
8400
8401If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8402dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8403these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8404termination functions in shared libraries:
8405@end defmac
8406
8407@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8408Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8409which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
8410@end defmac
8411
8412@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8413Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8414of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8415of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8416from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8417code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8418line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8419@end defmac
8420
8421@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8422Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8423library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8424strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8425constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8426that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8427@end defmac
8428
8429@node Instruction Output
8430@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8431
8432@c prevent bad page break with this line
8433This describes assembler instruction output.
8434
8435@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8436A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8437registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8438register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8439@end defmac
8440
8441@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8442If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8443and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8444registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8445to registers using alternate names.
8446@end defmac
8447
8448@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8449Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8450requires different names for the machine instructions.
8451
8452The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8453assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8454macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8455points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8456written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8457opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8458increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8459so that it will not be output twice.
8460
8461In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8462name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8463that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8464care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8465@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8466
8467@findex recog_data.operand
8468If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8469elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8470
8471If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8472in the usual way.
8473@end defmac
8474
8475@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8476If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8477assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8478they will be output differently.
8479
8480Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8481extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8482elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8483The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8484template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8485by changing the contents of the vector.
8486
8487This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8488file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8489can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8490as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8491syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8492writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8493
8494If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8495@end defmac
8496
8497@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8498If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8499output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8500if necessary.
8501
8502Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8503extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8504elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8505The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8506template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8507by checking the contents of the vector.
8508@end deftypefn
8509
8510@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8511A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8512assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8513RTL expression.
8514
8515@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8516of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8517printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8518the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8519operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8520@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8521@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8522
8523@findex reg_names
8524If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8525The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8526@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8527@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8528
8529When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8530(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8531with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8532@var{code}.
8533@end defmac
8534
8535@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8536A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8537punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8538@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8539punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8540in this way.
8541@end defmac
8542
8543@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8544A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8545assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8546whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8547
8548@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8549On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8550section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8551@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8552@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8553Format}.
8554@end defmac
8555
8556@findex dbr_sequence_length
8557@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8558A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8559been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8560determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8561currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8562or whatever.
8563
8564Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8565reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8566explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8567@end defmac
8568
8569@findex final_sequence
8570Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8571prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8572(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8573found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8574processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8575being output.
8576
8577@findex asm_fprintf
8578@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8579@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8580@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8581@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8582If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8583@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8584@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8585support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8586files can define these macros differently.
8587@end defmac
8588
8589@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8590If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8591statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8592the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8593printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8594statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8595generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8596specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8597The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8598string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8599upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8600@end defmac
8601
8602@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8603If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8604different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8605numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8606first variant.
8607
8608If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8609@smallexample
8610@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8611@end smallexample
8612@noindent
8613in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8614first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8615@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8616@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8617within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8618alternatives within the braces than the value of
8619@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8620
8621If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8622@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8623operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8624
8625Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8626@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8627the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8628@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8629if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8630opcodes or operand order.
8631@end defmac
8632
8633@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8634A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8635which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8636The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8637profiling.
8638@end defmac
8639
8640@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8641A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8642which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8643The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8644profiling.
8645@end defmac
8646
8647@node Dispatch Tables
8648@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8649
8650@c prevent bad page break with this line
8651This concerns dispatch tables.
8652
8653@cindex dispatch table
8654@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8655A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8656pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8657@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8658definitions of these labels are output using
8659@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8660way here. For example,
8661
8662@smallexample
8663fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8664 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8665@end smallexample
8666
8667You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8668dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8669will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8670@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8671mode and flags can be read.
8672@end defmac
8673
8674@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8675This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8676in a dispatch table are absolute.
8677
8678The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8679@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8680a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8681definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8682For example,
8683
8684@smallexample
8685fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8686@end smallexample
8687@end defmac
8688
8689@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8690Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8691specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8692@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8693jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8694@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8695
8696This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8697for the table.
8698
8699If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8700@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8701@end defmac
8702
8703@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8704Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8705jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8706after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8707the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8708@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8709of the preceding label.
8710
8711If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8712the jump-table.
8713@end defmac
8714
8715@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8716This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8717should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8718should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8719function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8720The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8721exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8722true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8723
8724The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8725@end deftypefn
8726
8727@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8728This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8729It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8730to be broken up according to function.
8731
8732The default is that no label is emitted.
8733@end deftypefn
8734
a68b5e52
RH
8735@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8736
38f8b050
JR
8737@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8738This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8739given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8740returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8741@end deftypefn
8742
3bc6b3e6
RH
8743@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8744
38f8b050
JR
8745@node Exception Region Output
8746@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8747
8748@c prevent bad page break with this line
8749
8750This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8751region.
8752
8753@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8754If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8755exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8756provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8757@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8758
8759You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8760unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8761@end defmac
8762
8763@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8764If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8765data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8766might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8767collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8768
8769Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8770also defined.
8771@end defmac
8772
8773@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8774Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8775information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8776runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8777and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8778@end defmac
8779
8780@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8781An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8782that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8783@end defmac
8784
8785@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8786Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8787information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8788Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8789@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8790or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8791@end defmac
38f8b050 8792
f0a0390e
RH
8793@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8794This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8795by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8796should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8797@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8798should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8799information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8800
f0a0390e
RH
8801A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8802This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8803default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8804
f0a0390e
RH
8805Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8806not depend on anything except command-line switches. In particular, the
8807setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8808macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8809depending on this setting.
8810
8811The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8812@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8813@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.
8814@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8815
8816@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8817This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8818tables even when exceptions are not used.
8819@end deftypevr
8820
8821@defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
8822This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
8823runtime-variable. In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
8824determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
8825so the target must provide it directly.
8826@end defmac
8827
8828@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8829Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8830should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8831instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8832@end defmac
8833
8834@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8835This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8836function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8837@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8838alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8839minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8840the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8841@end defmac
8842
8843@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8844Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8845end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8846Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8847true otherwise.
8848@end deftypevr
8849
8850@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8851Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8852represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8853register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8854locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8855register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8856If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8857@end deftypefn
8858
8859@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8860If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8861multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8862sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8863It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8864filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8865@var{address} is the address of the table.
8866@end deftypefn
8867
8868@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8869This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8870the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8871if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8872reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8873@end deftypefn
8874
8875@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8876This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8877based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8878the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8879running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8880@end deftypevr
8881
8882@node Alignment Output
8883@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8884
8885@c prevent bad page break with this line
8886This describes commands for alignment.
8887
8888@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8889The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8890a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8891
8892This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8893to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8894define the macro.
8895
8896Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8897to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8898@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8899selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8900@end defmac
8901
ad0c4c36
DD
8902@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8903The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8904@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8905@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8906@end deftypefn
8907
38f8b050
JR
8908@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8909The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8910a @code{BARRIER}.
8911
8912This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8913to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8914define the macro.
8915@end defmac
8916
ad0c4c36
DD
8917@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8918The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8919@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8920@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8921@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8922
8923@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8924The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8925a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8926
8927This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8928to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8929define the macro.
8930
8931Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8932to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8933@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8934selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8935@end defmac
8936
ad0c4c36
DD
8937@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8938The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8939@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8940defined.
8941@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8942
8943@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8944The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8945If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8946the maximum of the specified values is used.
8947
8948Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8949to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8950@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8951selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8952@end defmac
8953
ad0c4c36
DD
8954@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8955The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8956to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8957is defined.
8958@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8959
8960@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8961A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8962instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8963Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8964expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8965@end defmac
8966
8967@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8968Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8969text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8970This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8971produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8972section.
8973@end defmac
8974
8975@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8976A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8977command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8978@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8979@end defmac
8980
8981@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8982Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8983for padding, if necessary.
8984@end defmac
8985
8986@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8987A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8988command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8989@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8990satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8991a C expression of type @code{int}.
8992@end defmac
8993
8994@need 3000
8995@node Debugging Info
8996@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
8997
8998@c prevent bad page break with this line
8999This describes how to specify debugging information.
9000
9001@menu
9002* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9003* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9004* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9005* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9006* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9007* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9008@end menu
9009
9010@node All Debuggers
9011@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9012
9013@c prevent bad page break with this line
9014These macros affect all debugging formats.
9015
9016@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9017A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9018register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9019of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9020some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9021versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9022compiler and another for DBX@.
9023
9024If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9025used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9026consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9027Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9028expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9029
9030If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9031does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9032redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9033@end defmac
9034
9035@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9036A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9037variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9038computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9039gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9040that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9041for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9042@option{-g} options is used.
9043@end defmac
9044
9045@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9046A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9047having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9048@var{offset}.
9049@end defmac
9050
9051@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9052A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9053produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9054this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9055debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9056@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9057@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9058
9059When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9060value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9061exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9062value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9063defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9064
9065The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9066user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9067@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9068@end defmac
9069
9070@node DBX Options
9071@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9072
9073@c prevent bad page break with this line
9074These are specific options for DBX output.
9075
9076@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9077Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9078in response to the @option{-g} option.
9079@end defmac
9080
9081@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9082Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9083in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9084@end defmac
9085
9086@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9087Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9088GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9089debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9090macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9091if there is any occasion to.
9092@end defmac
9093
9094@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9095Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9096in the text section.
9097@end defmac
9098
9099@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9100A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9101use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9102If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9103applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9104@end defmac
9105
9106@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9107A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9108use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9109value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9110@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9111information format.
9112@end defmac
9113
9114@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9115A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9116use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9117name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9118macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9119@end defmac
9120
9121@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9122Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9123@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9124describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9125On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9126@end defmac
9127
9128@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9129A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9130continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9131exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9132operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9133must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9134with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9135defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9136@end defmac
9137
9138@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9139Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9140the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9141a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9142constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9143if backslash is correct for your system.
9144@end defmac
9145
9146@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9147Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9148outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9149variable.
9150@end defmac
9151
9152@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9153The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9154for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9155@end defmac
9156
9157@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9158The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9159for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9160provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9161@end defmac
9162
9163@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9164The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9165for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9166``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9167@end defmac
9168
9169@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9170The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9171passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9172do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9173@end defmac
9174
9175@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9176Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9177arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9178in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9179code.
9180@end defmac
9181
9182@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9183Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9184the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9185relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9186an absolute address.
9187@end defmac
9188
9189@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9190Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9191the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9192start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9193@end defmac
9194
9195@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9196Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9197@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9198macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9199number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9200generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9201number for a type number.
9202@end defmac
9203
9204@node DBX Hooks
9205@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9206
9207@c prevent bad page break with this line
9208These are hooks for DBX format.
9209
9210@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9211Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9212information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9213argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9214@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9215@end defmac
9216
9217@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9218Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9219@end defmac
9220
9221@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9222Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9223output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9224@end defmac
9225
9226@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9227A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9228number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9229@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9230invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9231unique labels in the assembly output.
9232
9233This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9234if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9235@end defmac
9236
9237@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9238Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9239@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9240On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9241disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9242@end defmac
9243
9244@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9245Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9246extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9247feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9248@end defmac
9249
9250@node File Names and DBX
9251@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9252
9253@c prevent bad page break with this line
9254This describes file names in DBX format.
9255
9256@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9257A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9258@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9259file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9260This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9261
9262This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9263for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9264
9265It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9266text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9267to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9268@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9269@end defmac
9270
9271@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9272Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9273of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9274the beginning of the file.
9275@end defmac
9276
9277@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9278Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9279that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9280an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9281@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9282@end defmac
9283
9284@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9285A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9286compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9287written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9288
9289If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9290of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9291@end defmac
9292
9293@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9294Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9295@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9296the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9297whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9298@end defmac
9299
9300@need 2000
9301@node SDB and DWARF
9302@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9303
9304@c prevent bad page break with this line
9305Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9306
9307@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9308Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9309for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9310@end defmac
9311
9312@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9313Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9314debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9315
9316@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9317Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9318be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9319value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9320@end deftypefn
9321
9322To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9323define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9324@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9325prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9326as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9327@end defmac
9328
9329@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9330Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9331Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9332(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9333exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9334how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9335@end defmac
9336
f0a0390e
RH
9337@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9338This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9339unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9340@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9341return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9342
9343A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9344is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9345
9346A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9347This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9348@end deftypefn
9349
38f8b050
JR
9350@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9351Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9352line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9353tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9354@end defmac
9355
9730bc27
TT
9356@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9357
38f8b050
JR
9358@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9359A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9360@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9361@end defmac
9362
9363@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9364A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9365between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9366slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9367@end defmac
9368
9369@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9370A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9371section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9372given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9373@end defmac
9374
9375@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9376A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9377reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9378@end defmac
9379
9380@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9381A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9382the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9383is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9384is referenced by a function.
9385@end defmac
9386
9387@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9388If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9389reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9390@end deftypefn
9391
9392@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9393Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9394SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9395macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9396not define them yourself.
9397@end defmac
9398
9399@defmac SDB_DELIM
9400Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9401SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9402delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9403a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9404required.
9405@end defmac
9406
9407@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9408Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9409union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9410allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9411it.
9412@end defmac
9413
9414@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9415Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9416enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9417assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9418@end defmac
9419
9420@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9421A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9422number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9423@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9424@end defmac
9425
9426@need 2000
9427@node VMS Debug
9428@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9429
9430@c prevent bad page break with this line
9431Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9432
9433@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9434Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9435in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9436is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9437@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9438behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9439@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9440@end defmac
9441
9442@node Floating Point
9443@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9444@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9445@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9446
9447While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9448there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9449means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9450in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9451doing the compilation.
9452
9453Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9454range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9455the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9456safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9457the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9458emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9459target floating point formats are identical.
9460
9461The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9462use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9463floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9464their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9465
9466@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9467The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9468machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9469array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9470quantity.
9471@end defmac
9472
9473@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9474Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9475floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9476@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9477@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9478@end deftypefn
9479
9480@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9481Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9482@end deftypefn
9483
9484@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9485Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9486@end deftypefn
9487
9488@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9489Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9490@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9491@end deftypefn
9492
9493@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9494Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9495representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9496decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9497defined by the C language for both.
9498@end deftypefn
9499
9500@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9501Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9502@end deftypefn
9503
9504@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9505Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9506@end deftypefn
9507
9508@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9509Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9510@end deftypefn
9511
9512@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9513Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9514@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9515variable).
9516
9517The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9518following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9519@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9520
9521If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9522target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9523@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9524@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9525@end deftypefn
9526
9527@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9528Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9529@end deftypefn
9530
9531@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9532Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9533@end deftypefn
9534
9535@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9536Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9537return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9538appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9539precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9540@end deftypefn
9541
9542@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9543Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9544which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9545integral, it is truncated.
9546@end deftypefn
9547
9548@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9549Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9550into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9551value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9552@end deftypefn
9553
9554@node Mode Switching
9555@section Mode Switching Instructions
9556@cindex mode switching
9557The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9558
9559@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9560Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9561switching in an optimizing compilation.
9562
9563For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9564floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9565the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9566operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9567purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9568be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9569or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9570
9571You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9572which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9573return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9574If you define this macro, you also have to define
9575@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9576@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9577@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9578are optional.
9579@end defmac
9580
9581@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9582If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9583initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9584N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9585of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9586The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9587zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9588entity in question.
9589In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9590represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9591switch is needed / supplied.
9592@end defmac
9593
9594@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9595@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9596@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9597return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9598@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9599be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9600@end defmac
9601
9602@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9603If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9604mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9605different from the incoming mode).
9606@end defmac
9607
9608@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9609If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9610mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9611@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9612is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9613@end defmac
9614
9615@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9616If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9617mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9618@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9619is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9620@end defmac
9621
9622@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9623This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96240 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9625lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9626for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9627(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9628@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9629@end defmac
9630
9631@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9632Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9633@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9634the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9635@end defmac
9636
9637@node Target Attributes
9638@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9639@cindex target attributes
9640@cindex machine attributes
9641@cindex attributes, target-specific
9642
9643Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9644These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9645be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9646
9647@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9648If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9649attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9650specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9651entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9652take.
9653@end deftypevr
9654
9655@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9656If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9657machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9658given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9659subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9660false for all machine-specific attributes.
9661@end deftypefn
9662
9663@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9664If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9665@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9666and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9667generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9668supposed always to be compatible.
9669@end deftypefn
9670
9671@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9672If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9673the newly defined @var{type}.
9674@end deftypefn
9675
9676@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9677Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9678handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9679@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9680that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9681function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9682merging.
9683@end deftypefn
9684
9685@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9686Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9687handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9688@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9689@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9690when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9691attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9692call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9693
9694@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9695If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9696for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9697@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9698will then define a function called
9699@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9700the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9701add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9702to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9703@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9704@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9705@end deftypefn
9706
9707@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9708
9709@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9710Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9711@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9712default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9713@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9714of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9715on this implementation detail.
9716@end defmac
9717
9718@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9719Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9720when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9721wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9722the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9723created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9724for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9725shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9726the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9727attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9728needed.
9729@end deftypefn
9730
9731@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9732@cindex inlining
9733This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9734into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9735attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9736target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9737@end deftypefn
9738
9739@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9740This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9741it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9742options for the current function that might be different than the
9743options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9744@code{true} if the options are valid.
9745
9746The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9747the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9748@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9749@end deftypefn
9750
9751@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9752This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9753in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9754options.
9755@xref{Option file format}.
9756@end deftypefn
9757
9758@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9759This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9760information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9761function specific options.
9762@end deftypefn
9763
9764@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9765This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9766information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9767function specific options.
9768@end deftypefn
9769
56cb42ea 9770@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9771This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9772set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9773input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9774@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9775@end deftypefn
9776
9777@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9778Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9779a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9780@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9781once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9782
9783Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9784@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9785
9786If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9787changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9788@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9789@end deftypefn
9790
9791@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9792This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9793cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9794default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9795specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9796@end deftypefn
9797
9798@node Emulated TLS
9799@section Emulating TLS
9800@cindex Emulated TLS
9801
9802For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9803specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9804used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9805configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9806the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9807layer.
9808
9809The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9810object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9811which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9812address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9813
9814@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9815Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9816object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9817emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9818@end deftypevr
9819
9820@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9821Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9822program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9823initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9824have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9825registration function to be used.
9826@end deftypevr
9827
9828@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9829Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9830be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9831any section.
9832@end deftypevr
9833
9834@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9835Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9836placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9837section.
9838@end deftypevr
9839
9840@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9841Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9842The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9843@end deftypevr
9844
9845@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9846Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9847default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9848@end deftypevr
9849
9850@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9851Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9852object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9853@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9854@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9855for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9856@end deftypefn
9857
9858@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9859Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9860TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9861is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9862initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9863@end deftypefn
9864
9865@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9866Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9867fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9868single objects. The default is false.
9869@end deftypevr
9870
9871@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9872Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9873may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9874@end deftypevr
9875
9876@node MIPS Coprocessors
9877@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9878@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9879
9880The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9881coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9882accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9883and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9884
9885@smallexample
9886 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9887 unsigned int d;
9888
9889 d = cp0count + 3;
9890@end smallexample
9891
9892(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9893names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9894overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9895
9896Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9897be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9898later in the function.
9899
9900Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9901the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9902floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9903
9904There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9905you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9906
9907@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9908A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9909alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9910@smallexample
9911@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9912@end smallexample
9913Default: empty.
9914@end defmac
9915
9916@node PCH Target
9917@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9918@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9919
9920@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9921This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9922@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9923@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9924@end deftypefn
9925
9926@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9927This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9928compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9929if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9930be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9931
9932@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9933when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9934It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9935compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9936
9937The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9938suitable for most targets.
9939@end deftypefn
9940
9941@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9942If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9943@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9944of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9945@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9946value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9947@end deftypefn
9948
9949@node C++ ABI
9950@section C++ ABI parameters
9951@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9952
9953@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9954Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9955These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9956default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9957@end deftypefn
9958
9959@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9960This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9961@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9962@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9963@end deftypefn
9964
9965@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9966This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9967whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9968known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9969@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9970IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9971@end deftypefn
9972
9973@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9974This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9975array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9976@end deftypefn
9977
9978@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9979If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9980class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9981will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9982to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9983modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9984backend's targeted operating system.
9985@end deftypefn
9986
9987@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9988This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9989the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9990@code{false}.
9991@end deftypefn
9992
9993@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
9994This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9995which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9996table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9997Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9998the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9999some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10000method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10001@end deftypefn
10002
10003@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10004
10005@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10006This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10007similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10008external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10009classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10010unit will not be COMDAT.
10011@end deftypefn
10012
10013@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10014This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10015the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10016be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10017@end deftypefn
10018
10019@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10020This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10021should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10022is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10023@end deftypefn
10024
10025@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10026This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10027in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10028destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10029shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10030unloaded. The default is to return false.
10031@end deftypefn
10032
10033@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10034
10035@node Named Address Spaces
10036@section Adding support for named address spaces
10037@cindex named address spaces
10038
10039The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10040standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10041support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10042processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10043GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10044address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10045spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10046@code{const} type attributes.
10047
10048Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10049pointers to the generic address space.
10050
10051For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10052to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10053processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10054issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10055local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10056address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10057@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10058always 32 bits).
10059
10060Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10061range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10062address space.
10063
10064To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10065the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10066the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10067named address space #1:
10068@smallexample
10069#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10070c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10071@end smallexample
10072
10073@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10074Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10075@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10076The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10077generic address space only.
10078@end deftypefn
10079
10080@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10081Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10082@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10083The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10084generic address space only.
10085@end deftypefn
10086
10087@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10088Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10089with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10090hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10091except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10092version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10093@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10094target hooks for the given address space.
10095@end deftypefn
10096
10097@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10098Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10099@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10100parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10101finished. This target hook is the same as the
10102@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10103explicit named address space support.
10104@end deftypefn
10105
10106@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10107Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10108with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10109hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10110except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10111@end deftypefn
10112
10113@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10114Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10115contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10116a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10117will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10118arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10119converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10120@end deftypefn
10121
10122@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10123Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10124@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10125space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10126to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10127guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10128as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10129@end deftypefn
10130
10131@node Misc
10132@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10133@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10134
10135@c prevent bad page break with this line
10136Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10137
10138@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10139Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10140has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10141conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10142blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10143set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10144to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10145@end defmac
10146
10147@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10148Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10149has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10150conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10151blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10152set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10153to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10154@end defmac
10155
10156@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10157An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10158elements of a jump-table should have.
10159@end defmac
10160
10161@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10162Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10163when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10164it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10165To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10166make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10167The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10168flags can be updated.
10169@end defmac
10170
10171@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10172Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10173should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10174jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10175contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10176is in effect.
10177@end defmac
10178
10179@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10180This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10181is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10182The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10183five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10184@end deftypefn
10185
10186@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10187Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10188statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10189advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10190of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10191targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10192@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10193@code{false} otherwise.
10194@end defmac
10195
10196@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10197Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10198smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10199Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10200@end defmac
10201
10202@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10203Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10204memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10205bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10206zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10207of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10208insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10209@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10210
10211This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10212greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10213value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10214@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10215define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10216
10217You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10218the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10219of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10220when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10221integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10222
10223You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10224mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10225@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10226is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10227@end defmac
10228
10229@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10230Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10231extends.
10232@end defmac
10233
10234@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10235Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10236point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10237unsigned one.
10238@end defmac
10239
10240@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10241When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10242divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10243the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10244that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10245of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10246has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10247@end deftypefn
10248
10249@defmac MOVE_MAX
10250The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10251between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10252@end defmac
10253
10254@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10255The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10256between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10257is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10258constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10259at run-time.
10260@end defmac
10261
10262@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10263A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10264actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10265of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10266this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10267a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10268truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10269instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10270include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10271also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10272arguments to bit-field instructions.
10273
10274If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10275position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10276instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10277
10278However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10279only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10280bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10281such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10282the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10283
10284You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10285@end defmac
10286
10287@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10288@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10289This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10290deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10291@xref{shift patterns}.
10292
10293On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10294shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10295equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10296this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10297otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10298particular behavior is guaranteed.
10299
10300Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10301@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10302that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10303
10304The default implementation of this function returns
10305@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10306and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10307@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10308nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10309by overriding it.
10310@end deftypefn
10311
10312@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10313A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10314``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10315bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10316operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10317
10318On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10319
10320@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10321@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10322When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10323modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10324If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10325such cases may improve things.
10326@end defmac
10327
10328@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10329The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10330are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10331@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10332sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10333otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10334representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10335@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10336@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10337@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10338widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10339
10340Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10341value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10342as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10343@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10344
10345Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10346describe two related properties. If you define
10347@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10348to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10349extension.
10350
10351In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10352@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10353@code{mode}.
10354@end deftypefn
10355
10356@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10357A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10358with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10359(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10360apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10361comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10362
10363A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10364comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10365and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10366which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10367true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10368operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10369@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10370@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10371the compiler.
10372
10373If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10374generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10375replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10376the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10377For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10378@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10379@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10380expression
10381
10382@smallexample
10383(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10384@end smallexample
10385
10386@noindent
10387can be converted to
10388
10389@smallexample
10390(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10391@end smallexample
10392
10393@noindent
10394where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10395tested into the sign bit.
10396
10397There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10398for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10399but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10400are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10401perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10402comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10403
10404Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10405from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10406choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10407to be used:
10408
10409@itemize @bullet
10410@item
10411Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10412@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10413``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10414comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10415combine the normalization with other operations.
10416
10417@item
10418For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10419slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10420other machines.
10421
10422@item
10423As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10424exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10425others.
10426
10427@item
10428Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10429@end itemize
10430
10431Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10432@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10433instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10434those cases, e.g., one matching
10435
10436@smallexample
10437(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10438@end smallexample
10439
10440Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10441condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10442@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10443machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10444and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10445@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10446@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10447find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10448
10449If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10450not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10451instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10452@end defmac
10453
10454@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10455A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10456returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10457Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10458floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10459this macro.
10460@end defmac
10461
10462@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10463A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10464for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10465mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10466this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10467return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10468this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10469@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10470the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10471given mode.
10472@end defmac
10473
10474@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10475@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10476A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10477for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10478A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10479If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10480evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10481entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10482the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10483In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10484this value.
10485
10486If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10487@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10488
10489This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10490relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10491is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10492to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10493
10494Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10495and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10496visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10497to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10498breaking the API@.
10499@end defmac
10500
10501@defmac Pmode
10502An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10503this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10504pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10505On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10506modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10507
10508The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10509@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10510@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10511to @code{Pmode}.
10512@end defmac
10513
10514@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10515An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10516being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10517where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10518@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10519size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10520as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10521@end defmac
10522
10523@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10524In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10525constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10526hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10527where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10528strict conformance to the C Standard.
10529
10530Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10531convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10532files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10533@end defmac
10534
10535@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10536Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10537This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10538C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10539@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10540@end defmac
10541
10542@findex #pragma
10543@findex pragma
10544@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10545Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10546If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10547@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10548for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10549setup required for the pragmas.
10550
10551The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10552other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10553definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10554
10555If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10556defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10557
10558Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10559@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10560silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10561@end defmac
10562
10563@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10564@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10565
10566Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10567@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10568@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10569pragma of the form
10570
10571@smallexample
10572#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10573@end smallexample
10574
10575@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10576@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10577routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10578on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10579@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10580callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10581a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10582arguments of pragmas registered with
10583@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10584pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10585
10586Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10587compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10588other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10589to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10590building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10591variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10592target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10593the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10594code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10595rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10596how to build this object file.
10597@end deftypefun
10598
10599@findex #pragma
10600@findex pragma
10601@defmac HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
10602Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
10603pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
10604[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
10605
10606The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
10607within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
10608@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
10609the behavior to the default.
10610
10611A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
10612(e.g.@: -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
10613When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
10614of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
10615bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
10616and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
10617chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
10618size is allocated).
10619
10620If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
10621the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
10622used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
10623precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
10624may affect its placement.
10625
10626The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
10627@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
10628of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
10629@end defmac
10630
10631@findex #pragma
10632@findex pragma
10633@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
10634Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
10635style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push[,@var{n}])} and @samp{#pragma
10636pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,[@var{n}])} pragma specifies the maximum
10637alignment (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as
10638the @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
10639pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
10640invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
10641that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
10642value.
10643@end defmac
10644
10645@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10646Define this macro, as well as
10647@code{HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA}, if macros should be expanded in the
10648arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10649@end defmac
10650
10651@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10652
10653@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10654If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10655the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10656This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10657@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10658@end defmac
10659
10660@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10661Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10662identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10663not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10664there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10665@end defmac
10666
10667@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10668Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10669@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10670G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10671@samp{.} is used instead.
10672@end defmac
10673
10674@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10675Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10676@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10677have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10678are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10679@end defmac
10680
10681@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10682Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10683delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10684even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10685@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10686every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10687or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10688you should define this macro.
10689
10690You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10691@end defmac
10692
10693@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10694Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10695delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10696even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10697@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10698some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10699are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10700define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10701instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10702slot of @var{insn}.
10703
10704You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10705@end defmac
10706
10707@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10708Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10709global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10710symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10711instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10712from shared libraries (DLLs).
10713
10714You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10715@end defmac
10716
10717@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10718This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10719any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10720It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10721clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10722corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10723clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10724@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10725for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10726@end deftypefn
10727
10728@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10729Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10730in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10731@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10732separate math library.
10733
d9d16a19 10734You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10735@end defmac
10736
10737@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10738Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10739specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10740
10741You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10742is wrong.
10743@end defmac
10744
10745@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10746Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10747functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10748Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10749to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10750if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10751for cross-profiling.
10752@end defmac
10753
10754@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10755
10756A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10757conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10758@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
107591 if it does use cc0.
10760@end defmac
10761
10762@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10763Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10764conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10765@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10766contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10767and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10768then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10769@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10770@end defmac
10771
10772@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10773Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10774if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10775@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10776being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10777@end defmac
10778
10779@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10780A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10781be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10782a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10783about the currently processed blocks.
10784@end defmac
10785
10786@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10787A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10788converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10789can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10790to by @var{ce_info}.
10791@end defmac
10792
10793@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10794A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10795converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10796can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10797to by @var{ce_info}.
10798@end defmac
10799
10800@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10801A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10802structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10803@end defmac
10804
10805@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10806If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10807added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10808by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10809@end defmac
10810
10811@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10812If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10813instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10814just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10815
10816The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10817it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10818laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10819Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10820
10821You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10822definition is null.
10823@end deftypefn
10824
10825@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10826Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10827that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10828necessary setup.
10829
10830Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10831instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10832they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10833instructions or prefetch instructions).
10834
10835To create a built-in function, call the function
10836@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10837which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10838up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10839only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10840@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10841@end deftypefn
10842
10843@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10844Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10845that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10846builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10847If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10848if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10849If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10850@code{error_mark_node}.
10851@end deftypefn
10852
10853@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10854
10855Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10856@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10857function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10858convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10859@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10860@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10861ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10862built-in function.
10863@end deftypefn
10864
d66f5459 10865@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10866Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10867was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10868@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10869implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10870declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10871arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10872complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10873another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10874@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10875@end deftypefn
10876
08914aaa 10877@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10878Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10879@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10880built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10881the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10882The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10883call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10884@end deftypefn
10885
10886@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10887
10888Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10889low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10890could not be applied.
10891
10892Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10893instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10894the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10895By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10896loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10897@end deftypefn
10898
10899@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10900
10901Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10902Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10903@var{branch2} is possible.
10904
10905On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10906filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10907may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10908@end defmac
10909
10910@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10911This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10912Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10913PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10914of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10915@end deftypefn
10916
10917@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10918
10919When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10920register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10921to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10922it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10923is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10924that had its initial value copied by using
10925@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10926Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10927to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10928the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10929@code{MEM}.
10930If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10931it might decide to use another register anyways.
10932You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10933that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10934register in question will not be clobbered.
10935The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10936allocation.
10937@end deftypefn
10938
10939@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10940This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10941@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10942this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10943@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10944to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10945passed along.
10946@end deftypefn
10947
10948@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10949The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10950context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10951the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10952per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10953attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10954The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10955and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10956and is returning to processing at the top level.
10957The default hook function does nothing.
10958
10959GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10960some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10961situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10962or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10963@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10964outside of any function scope.
10965@end deftypefn
10966
10967@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10968Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10969files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10970use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10971@end defmac
10972
10973@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10974Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10975automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10976do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10977executable files.
10978@end defmac
10979
10980@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10981If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10982specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10983Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10984object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10985lists.
10986@end defmac
10987
10988@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10989Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10990method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10991must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10992For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10993the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10994defined as this expression:
10995
10996@smallexample
10997build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10998 build_tree_list
10999 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11000 NULL))
11001@end smallexample
11002@end defmac
11003
11004@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
11005This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11006instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11007every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11008reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11009
11010@smallexample
11011static bool
11012cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11013@{
11014 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11015@}
11016@end smallexample
11017@end deftypefn
11018
11019@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
11020This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11021optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11022usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11023re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11024to inter-block scheduling.
11025@end deftypefn
11026
11027@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
11028Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11029registers
11030that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11031returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11032that all target registers in the class returned by
11033@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11034saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11035epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11036true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11037to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11038to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11039@end deftypefn
11040
11041@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11042This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11043This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11044modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11045@end deftypefn
11046
11047@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11048This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11049should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11050the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11051the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11052is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11053number of memory accesses.
11054@end deftypefn
11055
11056@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11057If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11058that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11059that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11060constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11061more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11062system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11063The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11064@end defmac
11065
11066@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11067This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11068target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11069are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11070The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11071@end deftypefn
11072
11073@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11074This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11075target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11076indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11077@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11078@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11079@end deftypefn
11080
11081@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11082This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11083The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11084systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11085that are different from @option{-I}.
11086@end deftypefn
11087
11088@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11089This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11090for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11091@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11092functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11093@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11094@end defmac
11095
11096@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11097If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11098target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11099option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11100@end defmac
11101
11102@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11103If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11104@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11105@end defmac
11106
11107@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11108If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11109target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11110default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11111@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11112@end defmac
11113
11114@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11115If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11116@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11117@end defmac
11118
11119@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11120If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11121routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11122and scanf formatter settings.
11123@end defmac
11124
11125@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11126If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11127guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11128main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11129important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11130many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11131``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11132and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11133@end deftypevr
11134
11135@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11136If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11137illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11138with prototype @var{typelist}.
11139@end deftypefn
11140
11141@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11142If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11143invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11144if validity should be determined by the front end.
11145@end deftypefn
11146
11147@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11148If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11149invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11150@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11151if validity should be determined by the front end.
11152@end deftypefn
11153
11154@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11155If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11156invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11157and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11158the front end.
11159@end deftypefn
11160
11161@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11162If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11163invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11164or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11165the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11166@end deftypefn
11167
11168@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11169If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11170invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11171or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11172the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11173@end deftypefn
11174
11175@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11176If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11177@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11178analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11179front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11180target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11181This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11182@end deftypefn
11183
11184@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11185If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11186@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11187or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11188This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11189conversion rules.
11190This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11191@end deftypefn
11192
11193@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11194This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11195classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11196SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11197@end defmac
11198
11199@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11200This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11201NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11202@end defmac
11203
11204@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11205Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11206to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11207call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11208and the associated definitions of those functions.
11209@end defmac
11210
11211@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11212Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11213necessary.
11214@end deftypefn
11215
11216@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11217This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11218different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11219argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11220is needed.
11221@end deftypefn
11222
11223@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11224When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11225arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11226stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11227debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11228@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11229cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11230to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11231false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11232@end deftypefn
11233
11234@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11235On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11236a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11237is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11238is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11239subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11240the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11241available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11242constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11243down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11244@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11245accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11246value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11247MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11248@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11249is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr